* gdb.texinfo (Breakpoint related warnings): New node.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
56
57 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
60 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
63
64 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67 development.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88 @sp 2
89 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
90 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
92 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
93
94 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
97 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
100
101 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104 development.''
105 @end titlepage
106 @page
107
108 @ifnottex
109 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
111 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
115 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
116 @value{GDBVN}.
117
118 Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
119
120 @menu
121 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128 * Stack:: Examining the stack
129 * Source:: Examining source files
130 * Data:: Examining data
131 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
132 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
133 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
134
135 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138 * Altering:: Altering execution
139 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
141 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
142 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
146 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
147 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
149 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
150
151 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
157 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
158 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
159 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
160 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
161 how you can copy and share GDB
162 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
163 * Index:: Index
164 @end menu
165
166 @end ifnottex
167
168 @contents
169
170 @node Summary
171 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
172
173 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
174 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
175 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
176
177 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
178 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
179
180 @itemize @bullet
181 @item
182 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
183
184 @item
185 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
186
187 @item
188 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
189
190 @item
191 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
192 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
193 @end itemize
194
195 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
196 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
197 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
198
199 @cindex Modula-2
200 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
201 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
202
203 @cindex Pascal
204 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
205 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
206 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
207 syntax.
208
209 @cindex Fortran
210 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
211 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
212 underscore.
213
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
215 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
216
217 @menu
218 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
219 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
220 @end menu
221
222 @node Free Software
223 @unnumberedsec Free software
224
225 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
226 General Public License
227 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
228 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
229 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
230 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
231 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
232 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
233
234 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
235 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
236 from anyone else.
237
238 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
239
240 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
241 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
242 include with the free software. Many of our most important
243 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
244 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
245 when an important free software package does not come with a free
246 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
247 gaps today.
248
249 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
250 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
251 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
252 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
253 them from the free software world.
254
255 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
256 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
257 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
258 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
259 contract to make it non-free.
260
261 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
262 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
263 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
264 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
265 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
266 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
267 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
268
269 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
270 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
271 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
272 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
273
274 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
275 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
276 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
277 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
278 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
279 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
280 community.
281
282 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
283 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
284 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
285 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
286 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
287 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
288 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
289 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
290 of the manual.
291
292 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
293 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
294 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
295 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
296 manual to replace it.
297
298 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
299 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
300 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
301 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
302 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
303 the free software community.
304
305 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
306 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
307 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
308 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
309 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
310 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
311 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
312 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
313 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
314
315 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
316 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
317 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
318 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
319 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
320 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
321 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
322 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
323
324 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
325 published by other publishers, at
326 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
327
328 @node Contributors
329 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
330
331 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
332 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
333 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
334 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
335 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
336 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
337 blow-by-blow account.
338
339 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
340
341 @quotation
342 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
343 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
344 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
345 @end quotation
346
347 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
348 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
349 releases:
350 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
351 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
352 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
353 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
354 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
355 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
356 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
357 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
358 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
359
360 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
361 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
362
363 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
364 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
365 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
366 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
367 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
368
369 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
370 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
371 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
372
373 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
374 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
375
376 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
377
378 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
379 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
380 support.
381 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
382 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
383 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
384 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
385 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
386 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
387 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
388 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
389 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
390 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
391 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
392 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
393 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
394 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
395 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
396 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
397
398 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
399
400 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401 libraries.
402
403 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404 about several machine instruction sets.
405
406 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409 and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412 command-line editing and command history.
413
414 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
416
417 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
418 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
419 symbols.
420
421 Renesas America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
422 Super-H processors.
423
424 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426 Renesas sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
427
428 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
429
430 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
431
432 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
433
434 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
435 watchpoints.
436
437 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
438
439 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
440
441 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
442 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
443
444 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
445 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
446 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
447 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
448 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
449 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
450 information in this manual.
451
452 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
453 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
454
455 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
456 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
457 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
458 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
459 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
460 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
461 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
462 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
463 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
464 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
465 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
466 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
467 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
468 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
469 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
470
471 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
472 Hat.
473
474 @node Sample Session
475 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
476
477 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
478 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
479 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
480
481 @iftex
482 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
483 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
484 @end iftex
485
486 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
487 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
488
489 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
490 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
491 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
492 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
493 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
494 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
495 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
496 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
497 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
498
499 @smallexample
500 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
501 $ @b{./m4}
502 @b{define(foo,0000)}
503
504 @b{foo}
505 0000
506 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
507
508 @b{bar}
509 0000
510 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
511
512 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
513 @b{baz}
514 @b{C-d}
515 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
516 @end smallexample
517
518 @noindent
519 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
520
521 @smallexample
522 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
523 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
524 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
525 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
526 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
527 the conditions.
528 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
529 for details.
530
531 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
532 (@value{GDBP})
533 @end smallexample
534
535 @noindent
536 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
537 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
538 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
539 that examples fit in this manual.
540
541 @smallexample
542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
543 @end smallexample
544
545 @noindent
546 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
547 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
548 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
549 @code{break} command.
550
551 @smallexample
552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
553 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
554 @end smallexample
555
556 @noindent
557 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
558 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
559 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
560
561 @smallexample
562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
563 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
564 @b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566 @b{foo}
567 0000
568 @end smallexample
569
570 @noindent
571 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
572 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
573 context where it stops.
574
575 @smallexample
576 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
577
578 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
579 at builtin.c:879
580 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
585 the next line of the current function.
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
589 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
590 : nil,
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
595 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
596 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
597 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
598
599 @smallexample
600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
601 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
602 at input.c:530
603 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
608 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
609 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
610 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
611 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
612 stack frame for each active subroutine.
613
614 @smallexample
615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
616 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
617 at input.c:530
618 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
619 at builtin.c:882
620 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
621 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
622 at macro.c:71
623 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
624 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
625 @end smallexample
626
627 @noindent
628 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
629 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
630 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
635 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
636 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
637 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
640 : xstrdup(rq);
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
647 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
648 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
649 (@code{print}) to see their values.
650
651 @smallexample
652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
653 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
655 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
660 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
661 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
665 533 xfree(rquote);
666 534
667 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
668 : xstrdup (lq);
669 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
670 : xstrdup (rq);
671 537
672 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
673 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
674 540 @}
675 541
676 542 void
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
681 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
682
683 @smallexample
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
687 540 @}
688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
689 $3 = 9
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
691 $4 = 7
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
696 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
697 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
698 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
699 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
700 assignments.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
704 $5 = 7
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
706 $6 = 9
707 @end smallexample
708
709 @noindent
710 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
711 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
712 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
713 example that caused trouble initially:
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
717 Continuing.
718
719 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
720
721 baz
722 0000
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
727 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
728 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
729
730 @smallexample
731 @b{C-d}
732 Program exited normally.
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
737 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
738 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
739
740 @smallexample
741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @node Invocation
745 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
746
747 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
748 The essentials are:
749 @itemize @bullet
750 @item
751 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
752 @item
753 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
754 @end itemize
755
756 @menu
757 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
758 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
759 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
760 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
761 @end menu
762
763 @node Invoking GDB
764 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
765
766 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
767 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
768
769 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
770 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
771
772 The command-line options described here are designed
773 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
774 options may effectively be unavailable.
775
776 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
777 specifying an executable program:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @noindent
784 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
785 specified:
786
787 @smallexample
788 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
789 @end smallexample
790
791 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
792 to debug a running process:
793
794 @smallexample
795 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
796 @end smallexample
797
798 @noindent
799 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
800 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
801
802 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
803 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
804 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
805 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
806 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
807
808 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
809 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
810 option processing.
811 @smallexample
812 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
813 @end smallexample
814 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
815 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
816
817 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
818 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} -silent
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
826 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
827
828 @noindent
829 Type
830
831 @smallexample
832 @value{GDBP} -help
833 @end smallexample
834
835 @noindent
836 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
837 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
838
839 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
840 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
841 @samp{-x} option is used.
842
843
844 @menu
845 * File Options:: Choosing files
846 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
847 @end menu
848
849 @node File Options
850 @subsection Choosing files
851
852 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
853 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
854 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
855 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
856 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
857 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
858 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
859 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
860 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
861 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
862 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
863 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
864 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
865
866 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
867 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
868 argument and ignore it.
869
870 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
871 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
872 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
873 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
874 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
875
876 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
877 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
878 @c it.
879
880 @table @code
881 @item -symbols @var{file}
882 @itemx -s @var{file}
883 @cindex @code{--symbols}
884 @cindex @code{-s}
885 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
886
887 @item -exec @var{file}
888 @itemx -e @var{file}
889 @cindex @code{--exec}
890 @cindex @code{-e}
891 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
892 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
893
894 @item -se @var{file}
895 @cindex @code{--se}
896 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
897 file.
898
899 @item -core @var{file}
900 @itemx -c @var{file}
901 @cindex @code{--core}
902 @cindex @code{-c}
903 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
904
905 @item -c @var{number}
906 @item -pid @var{number}
907 @itemx -p @var{number}
908 @cindex @code{--pid}
909 @cindex @code{-p}
910 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
911 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
912 file named @var{number}.
913
914 @item -command @var{file}
915 @itemx -x @var{file}
916 @cindex @code{--command}
917 @cindex @code{-x}
918 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
919 Files,, Command files}.
920
921 @item -directory @var{directory}
922 @itemx -d @var{directory}
923 @cindex @code{--directory}
924 @cindex @code{-d}
925 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
926
927 @item -m
928 @itemx -mapped
929 @cindex @code{--mapped}
930 @cindex @code{-m}
931 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
932 supported on all systems.}@*
933 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
934 system call, you can use this option
935 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
936 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
937 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
938 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
939 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
940 the symbol table from the executable program.
941
942 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
943 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
944 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
945
946 @item -r
947 @itemx -readnow
948 @cindex @code{--readnow}
949 @cindex @code{-r}
950 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
951 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
952 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
953
954 @end table
955
956 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
957 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
958 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
959 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
960 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
961
962 @smallexample
963 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
964 @end smallexample
965
966 @node Mode Options
967 @subsection Choosing modes
968
969 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
970 batch mode or quiet mode.
971
972 @table @code
973 @item -nx
974 @itemx -n
975 @cindex @code{--nx}
976 @cindex @code{-n}
977 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
978 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
979 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
980 files}.
981
982 @item -quiet
983 @itemx -silent
984 @itemx -q
985 @cindex @code{--quiet}
986 @cindex @code{--silent}
987 @cindex @code{-q}
988 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
989 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
990
991 @item -batch
992 @cindex @code{--batch}
993 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
994 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
995 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
996 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
997 in the command files.
998
999 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1000 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1001 make this more useful, the message
1002
1003 @smallexample
1004 Program exited normally.
1005 @end smallexample
1006
1007 @noindent
1008 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1009 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1010 mode.
1011
1012 @item -nowindows
1013 @itemx -nw
1014 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1015 @cindex @code{-nw}
1016 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1017 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1018 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1019
1020 @item -windows
1021 @itemx -w
1022 @cindex @code{--windows}
1023 @cindex @code{-w}
1024 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1025 used if possible.
1026
1027 @item -cd @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--cd}
1029 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1030 instead of the current directory.
1031
1032 @item -fullname
1033 @itemx -f
1034 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1035 @cindex @code{-f}
1036 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1037 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1038 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1039 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1040 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1041 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1042 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1043 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1044 frame.
1045
1046 @item -epoch
1047 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1048 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1049 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1050 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1051 separate window.
1052
1053 @item -annotate @var{level}
1054 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1055 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1056 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1057 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1058 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1059 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1060 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1061 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1062 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1063
1064 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1065 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1066
1067 @item -async
1068 @cindex @code{--async}
1069 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1070 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1071 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1072 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1073 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1074 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1075 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1076 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1077 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1078 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1079 yet.)
1080 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1081 @c should be removed.
1082
1083 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1084 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1085 @samp{-noasync} option.
1086
1087 @item -noasync
1088 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1089 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1090
1091 @item --args
1092 @cindex @code{--args}
1093 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1094 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1095 This option stops option processing.
1096
1097 @item -baud @var{bps}
1098 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1099 @cindex @code{--baud}
1100 @cindex @code{-b}
1101 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1102 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1103
1104 @item -tty @var{device}
1105 @itemx -t @var{device}
1106 @cindex @code{--tty}
1107 @cindex @code{-t}
1108 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1109 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1110
1111 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1112 @item -tui
1113 @cindex @code{--tui}
1114 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1115 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1116 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1117 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1118 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1119 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1120
1121 @c @item -xdb
1122 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1123 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1124 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1125 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1126 @c systems.
1127
1128 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1129 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1130 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1131 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1132 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1133 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1134
1135 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1136 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1137 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included in @var{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1138 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3,
1139 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1140 interfaces are not supported.
1141
1142 @item -write
1143 @cindex @code{--write}
1144 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1145 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1146 (@pxref{Patching}).
1147
1148 @item -statistics
1149 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1150 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1151 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1152
1153 @item -version
1154 @cindex @code{--version}
1155 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1156 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1157
1158 @end table
1159
1160 @node Quitting GDB
1161 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1162 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1163 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1164
1165 @table @code
1166 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1167 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1168 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1169 @itemx q
1170 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1171 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1172 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1173 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1174 error code.
1175 @end table
1176
1177 @cindex interrupt
1178 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1179 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1180 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1181 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1182 until a time when it is safe.
1183
1184 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1185 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1186 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1187
1188 @node Shell Commands
1189 @section Shell commands
1190
1191 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1192 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1193 just use the @code{shell} command.
1194
1195 @table @code
1196 @kindex shell
1197 @cindex shell escape
1198 @item shell @var{command string}
1199 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1200 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1201 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1202 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1203 @end table
1204
1205 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1206 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1207 @value{GDBN}:
1208
1209 @table @code
1210 @kindex make
1211 @cindex calling make
1212 @item make @var{make-args}
1213 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1214 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1215 @end table
1216
1217 @node Logging output
1218 @section Logging output
1219 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1220
1221 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1222 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1223
1224 @table @code
1225 @kindex set logging
1226 @item set logging on
1227 Enable logging.
1228 @item set logging off
1229 Disable logging.
1230 @item set logging file @var{file}
1231 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1232 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1233 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1234 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1235 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1236 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1237 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1238 @kindex show logging
1239 @item show logging
1240 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1241 @end table
1242
1243 @node Commands
1244 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1245
1246 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1247 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1248 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1249 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1250 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1251
1252 @menu
1253 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1254 * Completion:: Command completion
1255 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1256 @end menu
1257
1258 @node Command Syntax
1259 @section Command syntax
1260
1261 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1262 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1263 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1264 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1265 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1266 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1267
1268 @cindex abbreviation
1269 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1270 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1271 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1272 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1273 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1274 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1275 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1276
1277 @cindex repeating commands
1278 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1279 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1280 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1281 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1282 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1283 repeat.
1284
1285 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1286 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1287 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1288
1289 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1290 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1291 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1292 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1293 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1294
1295 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1296 @cindex comment
1297 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1298 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1299 Files,,Command files}).
1300
1301 @cindex repeating command sequences
1302 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1303 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1304 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1305 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1306 for editing.
1307
1308 @node Completion
1309 @section Command completion
1310
1311 @cindex completion
1312 @cindex word completion
1313 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1314 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1315 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1316 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1317
1318 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1319 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1320 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1321 enter it). For example, if you type
1322
1323 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1324 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1325 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1326 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1327 @smallexample
1328 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1329 @end smallexample
1330
1331 @noindent
1332 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1333 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1334
1335 @smallexample
1336 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1337 @end smallexample
1338
1339 @noindent
1340 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1341 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1342 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1343 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1344 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1345 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1346
1347 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1348 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1349 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1350 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1351 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1352 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1353 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1354 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1355 example:
1356
1357 @smallexample
1358 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1359 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1360 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1361 make_abs_section make_function_type
1362 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1363 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1364 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1365 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1366 @end smallexample
1367
1368 @noindent
1369 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1370 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1371 command.
1372
1373 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1374 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1375 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1376 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1377 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1378
1379 @cindex quotes in commands
1380 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1381 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1382 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1383 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1384 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1385 @value{GDBN} commands.
1386
1387 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1388 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1389 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1390 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1391 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1392 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1393 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1394 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1395 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1396 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1397 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1398
1399 @smallexample
1400 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1401 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1402 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1403 @end smallexample
1404
1405 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1406 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1407 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1408 place:
1409
1410 @smallexample
1411 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1412 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1413 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1414 @end smallexample
1415
1416 @noindent
1417 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1418 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1419 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1420
1421 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1422 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1423 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1424 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1425
1426
1427 @node Help
1428 @section Getting help
1429 @cindex online documentation
1430 @kindex help
1431
1432 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1433 using the command @code{help}.
1434
1435 @table @code
1436 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1437 @item help
1438 @itemx h
1439 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1440 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1441
1442 @smallexample
1443 (@value{GDBP}) help
1444 List of classes of commands:
1445
1446 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1447 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1448 data -- Examining data
1449 files -- Specifying and examining files
1450 internals -- Maintenance commands
1451 obscure -- Obscure features
1452 running -- Running the program
1453 stack -- Examining the stack
1454 status -- Status inquiries
1455 support -- Support facilities
1456 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1457 stopping the program
1458 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1459
1460 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1461 commands in that class.
1462 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1463 documentation.
1464 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1465 (@value{GDBP})
1466 @end smallexample
1467 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1468
1469 @item help @var{class}
1470 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1471 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1472 help display for the class @code{status}:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1476 Status inquiries.
1477
1478 List of commands:
1479
1480 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1481 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1482 info -- Generic command for showing things
1483 about the program being debugged
1484 show -- Generic command for showing things
1485 about the debugger
1486
1487 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1488 documentation.
1489 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1490 (@value{GDBP})
1491 @end smallexample
1492
1493 @item help @var{command}
1494 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1495 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1496
1497 @kindex apropos
1498 @item apropos @var{args}
1499 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1500 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1501 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1502
1503 @smallexample
1504 apropos reload
1505 @end smallexample
1506
1507 @noindent
1508 results in:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 @c @group
1512 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1513 multiple times in one run
1514 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1515 multiple times in one run
1516 @c @end group
1517 @end smallexample
1518
1519 @kindex complete
1520 @item complete @var{args}
1521 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1522 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1523 command you want completed. For example:
1524
1525 @smallexample
1526 complete i
1527 @end smallexample
1528
1529 @noindent results in:
1530
1531 @smallexample
1532 @group
1533 if
1534 ignore
1535 info
1536 inspect
1537 @end group
1538 @end smallexample
1539
1540 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1541 @end table
1542
1543 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1544 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1545 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1546 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1547 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1548 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1549
1550 @c @group
1551 @table @code
1552 @kindex info
1553 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1554 @item info
1555 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1556 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1557 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1558 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1559 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1560 @w{@code{help info}}.
1561
1562 @kindex set
1563 @item set
1564 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1565 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1566 @code{set prompt $}.
1567
1568 @kindex show
1569 @item show
1570 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1571 @value{GDBN} itself.
1572 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1573 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1574 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1575 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1576
1577 @kindex info set
1578 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1579 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1580 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1581 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1582 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1583 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1584 @end table
1585 @c @end group
1586
1587 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1588 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1589
1590 @table @code
1591 @kindex show version
1592 @cindex version number
1593 @item show version
1594 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1595 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1596 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1597 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1598 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1599 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1600 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1601 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1602 @value{GDBN}.
1603
1604 @kindex show copying
1605 @item show copying
1606 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1607
1608 @kindex show warranty
1609 @item show warranty
1610 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1611 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1612
1613 @end table
1614
1615 @node Running
1616 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1617
1618 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1619 debugging information when you compile it.
1620
1621 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1622 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1623 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1624 kill a child process.
1625
1626 @menu
1627 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1628 * Starting:: Starting your program
1629 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1630 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1631
1632 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1633 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1634 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1635 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1636
1637 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1638 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1639 @end menu
1640
1641 @node Compilation
1642 @section Compiling for debugging
1643
1644 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1645 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1646 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1647 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1648 and addresses in the executable code.
1649
1650 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1651 the compiler.
1652
1653 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1654 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1655 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1656 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1657 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1658 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1659 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1660 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1661 @option{-g} alone.
1662
1663 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1664 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1665 executables containing debugging information.
1666
1667 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1668 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1669 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1670 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1671 in pushing your luck.
1672
1673 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1674 @cindex debugging optimized code
1675 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1676 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1677 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1678 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1679 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1680 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1681
1682 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1683 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1684 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1685 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1686
1687 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1688 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1689 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1690
1691 @need 2000
1692 @node Starting
1693 @section Starting your program
1694 @cindex starting
1695 @cindex running
1696
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex run
1699 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1700 @item run
1701 @itemx r
1702 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1703 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1704 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1705 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1706 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1707
1708 @end table
1709
1710 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1711 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1712 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1713 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1714
1715 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1716 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1717 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1718 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1719 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1720 divided into four categories:
1721
1722 @table @asis
1723 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1724 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1725 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1726 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1727 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1728 the arguments.
1729 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1730 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1731 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1732
1733 @item The @emph{environment.}
1734 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1735 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1736 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1737 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1738
1739 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1740 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1741 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1742 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1743
1744 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1745 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1746 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1747 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1748 set a different device for your program.
1749 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1750
1751 @cindex pipes
1752 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1753 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1754 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1755 wrong program.
1756 @end table
1757
1758 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1759 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1760 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1761 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1762 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1763
1764 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1765 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1766 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1767 your current breakpoints.
1768
1769 @node Arguments
1770 @section Your program's arguments
1771
1772 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1773 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1774 @code{run} command.
1775 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1776 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1777 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1778 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1779 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1780
1781 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1782 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1783 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1784 the program, not by the shell.
1785
1786 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1787 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1788
1789 @table @code
1790 @kindex set args
1791 @item set args
1792 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1793 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1794 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1795 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1796 it again without arguments.
1797
1798 @kindex show args
1799 @item show args
1800 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1801 @end table
1802
1803 @node Environment
1804 @section Your program's environment
1805
1806 @cindex environment (of your program)
1807 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1808 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1809 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1810 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1811 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1812 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1813 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1814
1815 @table @code
1816 @kindex path
1817 @item path @var{directory}
1818 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1819 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1820 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1821 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1822 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1823 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1824 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1825
1826 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1827 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1828 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1829 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1830 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1831 @var{directory} to the search path.
1832 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1833 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1834
1835 @kindex show paths
1836 @item show paths
1837 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1838 environment variable).
1839
1840 @kindex show environment
1841 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1842 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1843 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1844 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1845 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1846
1847 @kindex set environment
1848 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1849 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1850 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1851 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1852 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1853 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1854 null value.
1855 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1856 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1857
1858 For example, this command:
1859
1860 @smallexample
1861 set env USER = foo
1862 @end smallexample
1863
1864 @noindent
1865 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1866 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1867 are not actually required.)
1868
1869 @kindex unset environment
1870 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1871 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1872 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1873 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1874 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1878 the shell indicated
1879 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1880 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1881 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1882 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1883 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1884 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1885 @file{.profile}.
1886
1887 @node Working Directory
1888 @section Your program's working directory
1889
1890 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1891 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1892 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1893 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1894 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1895 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1896
1897 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1898 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1899 specify files}.
1900
1901 @table @code
1902 @kindex cd
1903 @item cd @var{directory}
1904 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1905
1906 @kindex pwd
1907 @item pwd
1908 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1909 @end table
1910
1911 @node Input/Output
1912 @section Your program's input and output
1913
1914 @cindex redirection
1915 @cindex i/o
1916 @cindex terminal
1917 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1918 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1919 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1920 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1921 running your program.
1922
1923 @table @code
1924 @kindex info terminal
1925 @item info terminal
1926 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1927 program is using.
1928 @end table
1929
1930 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1931 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1932
1933 @smallexample
1934 run > outfile
1935 @end smallexample
1936
1937 @noindent
1938 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1939
1940 @kindex tty
1941 @cindex controlling terminal
1942 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1943 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1944 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1945 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1946 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1947
1948 @smallexample
1949 tty /dev/ttyb
1950 @end smallexample
1951
1952 @noindent
1953 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1954 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1955 that as their controlling terminal.
1956
1957 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1958 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1959 terminal.
1960
1961 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1962 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1963 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1964
1965 @node Attach
1966 @section Debugging an already-running process
1967 @kindex attach
1968 @cindex attach
1969
1970 @table @code
1971 @item attach @var{process-id}
1972 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1973 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1974 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1975 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1976 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1977
1978 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1979 executing the command.
1980 @end table
1981
1982 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1983 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1984 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1985 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1986
1987 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1988 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1989 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1990 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1991 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1992 Specify Files}.
1993
1994 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1995 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1996 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1997 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1998 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1999 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2000 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2001
2002 @table @code
2003 @kindex detach
2004 @item detach
2005 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2006 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2007 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2008 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2009 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2010 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2011 executing the command.
2012 @end table
2013
2014 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2015 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2016 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2017 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2018 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2019 messages}).
2020
2021 @node Kill Process
2022 @section Killing the child process
2023
2024 @table @code
2025 @kindex kill
2026 @item kill
2027 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2028 @end table
2029
2030 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2031 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2032 is running.
2033
2034 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2035 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2036 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2037 outside the debugger.
2038
2039 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2040 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2041 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2042 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2043 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2044 breakpoint settings).
2045
2046 @node Threads
2047 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2048
2049 @cindex threads of execution
2050 @cindex multiple threads
2051 @cindex switching threads
2052 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2053 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2054 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2055 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2056 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2057 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2058 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2059
2060 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2061 programs:
2062
2063 @itemize @bullet
2064 @item automatic notification of new threads
2065 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2066 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2067 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2068 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2069 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2070 @end itemize
2071
2072 @quotation
2073 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2074 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2075 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2076 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2077 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2078 like this:
2079
2080 @smallexample
2081 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2082 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2083 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2084 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2085 @end smallexample
2086 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2087 @c doesn't support threads"?
2088 @end quotation
2089
2090 @cindex focus of debugging
2091 @cindex current thread
2092 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2093 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2094 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2095 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2096 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2097
2098 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2099 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2100 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2101 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2102 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2103 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2104 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2105 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2106 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2107 LynxOS, you might see
2108
2109 @smallexample
2110 [New process 35 thread 27]
2111 @end smallexample
2112
2113 @noindent
2114 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2115 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2116 further qualifier.
2117
2118 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2119 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2120 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2121 @c program?
2122 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2123 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2124 @c threads ab initio?
2125
2126 @cindex thread number
2127 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2128 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2129 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2130
2131 @table @code
2132 @kindex info threads
2133 @item info threads
2134 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2135 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2136
2137 @enumerate
2138 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2139
2140 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2141
2142 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2143 @end enumerate
2144
2145 @noindent
2146 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2147 indicates the current thread.
2148
2149 For example,
2150 @end table
2151 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2152
2153 @smallexample
2154 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2155 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2156 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2157 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2158 at threadtest.c:68
2159 @end smallexample
2160
2161 On HP-UX systems:
2162
2163 @cindex thread number
2164 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2165 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2166 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2167 thread in your program.
2168
2169 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2170 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2171 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2172 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2173 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2174 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2175 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2176 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2177 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2178 HP-UX, you see
2179
2180 @smallexample
2181 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2182 @end smallexample
2183
2184 @noindent
2185 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex info threads
2189 @item info threads
2190 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2191 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2192
2193 @enumerate
2194 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2195
2196 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2197
2198 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2199 @end enumerate
2200
2201 @noindent
2202 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2203 indicates the current thread.
2204
2205 For example,
2206 @end table
2207 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2211 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2212 at quicksort.c:137
2213 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2214 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2215 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2216 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 @table @code
2220 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2221 @item thread @var{threadno}
2222 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2223 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2224 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2225 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2226 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2227
2228 @smallexample
2229 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2230 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2231 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2232 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2233 @end smallexample
2234
2235 @noindent
2236 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2237 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2238 threads.
2239
2240 @kindex thread apply
2241 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2242 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2243 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2244 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2245 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2246 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2247 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2248 @end table
2249
2250 @cindex automatic thread selection
2251 @cindex switching threads automatically
2252 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2253 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2254 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2255 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2256 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2257 thread.
2258
2259 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2260 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2261 programs with multiple threads.
2262
2263 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2264 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2265
2266 @node Processes
2267 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2268
2269 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2270 @cindex multiple processes
2271 @cindex processes, multiple
2272 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2273 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2274 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2275 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2276 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2277 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2278 will cause it to terminate.
2279
2280 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2281 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2282 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2283 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2284 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2285 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2286 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2287 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2288 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2289 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2290
2291 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2292 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2293 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2294
2295 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2296 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2297
2298 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2299 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2303 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2304 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2305 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2306 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2307
2308 @table @code
2309 @item parent
2310 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2311 unimpeded. This is the default.
2312
2313 @item child
2314 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2315 unimpeded.
2316
2317 @item ask
2318 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2319 @end table
2320
2321 @item show follow-fork-mode
2322 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2323 @end table
2324
2325 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2326 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2327 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2328 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2329 the child process's @code{main}.
2330
2331 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2332 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2333
2334 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2335 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2336 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2337 argument.
2338
2339 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2340 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2341 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2342
2343 @node Stopping
2344 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2345
2346 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2347 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2348 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2349
2350 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2351 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2352 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2353 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2354 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2355 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2356 explicitly request this information at any time.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex info program
2360 @item info program
2361 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2362 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2363 @end table
2364
2365 @menu
2366 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2367 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2368 * Signals:: Signals
2369 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2370 @end menu
2371
2372 @node Breakpoints
2373 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2374
2375 @cindex breakpoints
2376 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2377 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2378 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2379 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2380 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2381 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2382 program.
2383
2384 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2385 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2386 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2387 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2388 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2389 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2390
2391 @cindex watchpoints
2392 @cindex memory tracing
2393 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2394 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2395 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2396 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2397 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2398 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2399 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2400 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2401
2402 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2403 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2404 Automatic display}.
2405
2406 @cindex catchpoints
2407 @cindex breakpoint on events
2408 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2409 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2410 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2411 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2412 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2413 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2414 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2415
2416 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2417 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2418 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2419 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2420 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2421 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2422 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2423 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2424 enable it again.
2425
2426 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2427 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2428 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2429 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2430 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2431 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2432 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2433
2434 @menu
2435 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2436 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2437 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2438 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2439 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2440 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2441 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2442 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2443 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2444 @end menu
2445
2446 @node Set Breaks
2447 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2448
2449 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2450 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2451 @c
2452 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2453
2454 @kindex break
2455 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2456 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2457 @cindex latest breakpoint
2458 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2459 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2460 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2461 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2462 convenience variables.
2463
2464 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2465
2466 @table @code
2467 @item break @var{function}
2468 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2469 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2470 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2471 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2472
2473 @item break +@var{offset}
2474 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2475 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2476 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2477 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2478
2479 @item break @var{linenum}
2480 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2481 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2482 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2483 code on that line.
2484
2485 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2486 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2487
2488 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2489 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2490 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2491 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2492 functions.
2493
2494 @item break *@var{address}
2495 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2496 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2497 information or source files.
2498
2499 @item break
2500 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2501 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2502 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2503 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2504 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2505 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2506 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2507 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2508 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2509 inside loops.
2510
2511 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2512 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2513 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2514 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2515 existed when your program stopped.
2516
2517 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2518 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2519 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2520 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2521 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2522 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2523 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2524
2525 @kindex tbreak
2526 @item tbreak @var{args}
2527 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2528 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2529 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2530 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2531
2532 @kindex hbreak
2533 @item hbreak @var{args}
2534 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2535 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2536 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2537 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2538 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2539 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2540 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2541 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2542 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2543 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2544 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2545 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2546 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2547 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2548 @xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2549
2550
2551 @kindex thbreak
2552 @item thbreak @var{args}
2553 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2554 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2555 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2556 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2557 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2558 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2559 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2560 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2561
2562 @kindex rbreak
2563 @cindex regular expression
2564 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2565 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2566 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2567 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2568 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2569 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2570 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2571
2572 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2573 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2574 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2575 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2576 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2577 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2578
2579 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2580 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2581 classes.
2582
2583 @kindex info breakpoints
2584 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2585 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2586 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2587 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2588 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2589 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2590
2591 @table @emph
2592 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2593 @item Type
2594 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2595 @item Disposition
2596 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2597 @item Enabled or Disabled
2598 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2599 that are not enabled.
2600 @item Address
2601 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2602 @item What
2603 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2604 line number.
2605 @end table
2606
2607 @noindent
2608 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2609 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2610 are listed after that.
2611
2612 @noindent
2613 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2614 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2615 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2616 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2617 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2618
2619 @noindent
2620 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2621 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2622 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2623 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2624 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2625 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2626 @end table
2627
2628 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2629 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2630 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2631 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2632
2633 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2634 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2635 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2636 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2637 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2638 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2639 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2640 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2641
2642
2643 @node Set Watchpoints
2644 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2645
2646 @cindex setting watchpoints
2647 @cindex software watchpoints
2648 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2649 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2650 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2651 this may happen.
2652
2653 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2654 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2655 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2656 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2657 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2658 culprit.)
2659
2660 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2661 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2662 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2663 program.
2664
2665 @table @code
2666 @kindex watch
2667 @item watch @var{expr}
2668 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2669 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2670
2671 @kindex rwatch
2672 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2673 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2674
2675 @kindex awatch
2676 @item awatch @var{expr}
2677 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2678 by the program.
2679
2680 @kindex info watchpoints
2681 @item info watchpoints
2682 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2683 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2684 @end table
2685
2686 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2687 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2688 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2689 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2690 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2691 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2692
2693 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2694
2695 @smallexample
2696 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2697 @end smallexample
2698
2699 @noindent
2700 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2701
2702 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2703 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2704 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2705 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2706 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2707 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2708 will print a message like this:
2709
2710 @smallexample
2711 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2712 @end smallexample
2713
2714 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2715 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2716 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2717 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2718 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2719 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2720 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2721 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2722
2723 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2724 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2725 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2726 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2727 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2728 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2729
2730 @smallexample
2731 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2732 @end smallexample
2733
2734 @noindent
2735 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2736
2737 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2738 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2739 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2740 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2741 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2742 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2743 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2744 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2745 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2746 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2747
2748 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2749 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2750 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2751
2752 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2753 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2754 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2755 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2756 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2757 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2758 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2759 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2760 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2761
2762 @quotation
2763 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2764 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2765 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2766 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2767 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2768 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2769 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2770 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2771 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2772 the expression.
2773
2774 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2775 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2776 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2777 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2778 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2779 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2780 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2781 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2782 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2783 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2784 @end quotation
2785
2786 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2787
2788 @node Set Catchpoints
2789 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2790 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2791 @cindex exception handlers
2792 @cindex event handling
2793
2794 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2795 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2796 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2797
2798 @table @code
2799 @kindex catch
2800 @item catch @var{event}
2801 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2802 @table @code
2803 @item throw
2804 @kindex catch throw
2805 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2806
2807 @item catch
2808 @kindex catch catch
2809 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2810
2811 @item exec
2812 @kindex catch exec
2813 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2814
2815 @item fork
2816 @kindex catch fork
2817 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2818
2819 @item vfork
2820 @kindex catch vfork
2821 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2822
2823 @item load
2824 @itemx load @var{libname}
2825 @kindex catch load
2826 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2827 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2828
2829 @item unload
2830 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2831 @kindex catch unload
2832 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2833 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2834 @end table
2835
2836 @item tcatch @var{event}
2837 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2838 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2839
2840 @end table
2841
2842 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2843
2844 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2845 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2846
2847 @itemize @bullet
2848 @item
2849 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2850 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2851 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2852 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2853 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2854 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2855 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2856 disabled within interactive calls.
2857
2858 @item
2859 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2860
2861 @item
2862 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2863 @end itemize
2864
2865 @cindex raise exceptions
2866 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2867 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2868 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2869 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2870 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2871 out where the exception was raised.
2872
2873 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2874 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2875 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2876 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2877
2878 @smallexample
2879 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2880 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2881 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2882 @end smallexample
2883
2884 @noindent
2885 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2886 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2887 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2888
2889 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2890 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2891 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2892 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2893 raised.
2894
2895
2896 @node Delete Breaks
2897 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2898
2899 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2900 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2901 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2902 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2903 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2904 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2905
2906 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2907 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2908 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2909 their breakpoint numbers.
2910
2911 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2912 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2913 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2914
2915 @table @code
2916 @kindex clear
2917 @item clear
2918 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2919 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2920 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2921 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2922
2923 @item clear @var{function}
2924 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2925 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2926
2927 @item clear @var{linenum}
2928 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2929 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2930
2931 @cindex delete breakpoints
2932 @kindex delete
2933 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2934 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2935 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2936 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2937 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2938 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2939 @end table
2940
2941 @node Disabling
2942 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2943
2944 @kindex disable breakpoints
2945 @kindex enable breakpoints
2946 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2947 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2948 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2949 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2950
2951 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2952 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2953 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2954 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2955 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2956
2957 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2958 states of enablement:
2959
2960 @itemize @bullet
2961 @item
2962 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2963 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2964 @item
2965 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2966 @item
2967 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2968 disabled.
2969 @item
2970 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2971 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2972 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2973 @end itemize
2974
2975 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2976 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2977
2978 @table @code
2979 @kindex disable breakpoints
2980 @kindex disable
2981 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2982 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2983 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2984 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2985 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2986 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2987 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2988
2989 @kindex enable breakpoints
2990 @kindex enable
2991 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2992 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2993 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2994
2995 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2996 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2997 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2998
2999 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3000 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3001 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3002 @end table
3003
3004 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3005 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3006 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3007 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3008 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3009 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3010 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3011 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3012 stepping}.)
3013
3014 @node Conditions
3015 @subsection Break conditions
3016 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3017 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3018
3019 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3020 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3021 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3022 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3023 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3024 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3025 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3026 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3027
3028 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3029 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3030 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3031 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3032 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3033
3034 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3035 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3036 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3037 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3038 one.
3039
3040 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3041 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3042 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3043 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3044 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3045 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3046 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3047 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3048 conditions for the
3049 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3050 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3051
3052 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3053 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3054 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3055 with the @code{condition} command.
3056
3057 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3058 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3059 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3060 catchpoint.
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex condition
3064 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3065 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3066 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3067 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3068 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3069 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3070 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3071 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3072 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3073 prints an error message:
3074
3075 @smallexample
3076 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3077 @end smallexample
3078
3079 @noindent
3080 @value{GDBN} does
3081 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3082 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3083 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3084
3085 @item condition @var{bnum}
3086 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3087 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3088 @end table
3089
3090 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3091 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3092 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3093 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3094 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3095 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3096 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3097 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3098 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3099 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3100 your program reaches it.
3101
3102 @table @code
3103 @kindex ignore
3104 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3105 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3106 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3107 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3108 takes no action.
3109
3110 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3111 a count of zero.
3112
3113 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3114 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3115 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3116 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3117
3118 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3119 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3120 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3121
3122 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3123 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3124 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3125 variables}.
3126 @end table
3127
3128 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3129
3130
3131 @node Break Commands
3132 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3133
3134 @cindex breakpoint commands
3135 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3136 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3137 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3138 enable other breakpoints.
3139
3140 @table @code
3141 @kindex commands
3142 @kindex end
3143 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3144 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3145 @itemx end
3146 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3147 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3148 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3149
3150 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3151 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3152
3153 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3154 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3155 recently encountered).
3156 @end table
3157
3158 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3159 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3160
3161 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3162 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3163 that resumes execution.
3164
3165 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3166 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3167 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3168 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3169 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3170
3171 @kindex silent
3172 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3173 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3174 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3175 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3176 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3177 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3178
3179 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3180 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3181 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3182
3183 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3184 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3185
3186 @smallexample
3187 break foo if x>0
3188 commands
3189 silent
3190 printf "x is %d\n",x
3191 cont
3192 end
3193 @end smallexample
3194
3195 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3196 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3197 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3198 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3199 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3200 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3201 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3202
3203 @smallexample
3204 break 403
3205 commands
3206 silent
3207 set x = y + 4
3208 cont
3209 end
3210 @end smallexample
3211
3212 @node Breakpoint Menus
3213 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3214 @cindex overloading
3215 @cindex symbol overloading
3216
3217 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3218 single function name
3219 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3220 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3221 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3222 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3223 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3224 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3225 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3226 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3227 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3228 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3229 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3230 breakpoints.
3231
3232 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3233 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3234 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3235
3236 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3237 @smallexample
3238 @group
3239 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3240 [0] cancel
3241 [1] all
3242 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3243 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3244 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3245 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3246 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3247 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3248 > 2 4 6
3249 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3250 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3251 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3252 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3253 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3254 breakpoints.
3255 (@value{GDBP})
3256 @end group
3257 @end smallexample
3258
3259 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3260 @node Error in Breakpoints
3261 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3262 @c
3263 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3264 @c
3265 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3266 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3267 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3268 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3272 The same program may be running in another process.
3273 @end smallexample
3274
3275 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3276
3277 @enumerate
3278 @item
3279 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3280
3281 @item
3282 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3283 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3284 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3285 Then start your program again.
3286
3287 @item
3288 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3289 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3290 to nonsharable executables.
3291 @end enumerate
3292 @c @end ifclear
3293
3294 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3295 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3296
3297 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3298 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3299 @smallexample
3300 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3301 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3302 @end smallexample
3303
3304 @noindent
3305 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3306 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3307 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3308
3309 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3310 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3311
3312 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3313 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3314 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3315
3316 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3317 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3318 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3319 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3320
3321 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3322 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3323 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3324 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3325 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3326 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3327 first in the bundle.
3328
3329 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3330 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3331 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3332 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3333 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3334 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3335 is hit.
3336
3337 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3338 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3339
3340 @smallexample
3341 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3342 @end smallexample
3343
3344 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3345 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3346 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3347 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3348 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3349 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3350 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3351 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3352
3353 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3354 adjusted breakpoints:
3355
3356 @smallexample
3357 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3358 to 0x00010410.
3359 @end smallexample
3360
3361 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3362 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3363 frequently than expected.
3364
3365 @node Continuing and Stepping
3366 @section Continuing and stepping
3367
3368 @cindex stepping
3369 @cindex continuing
3370 @cindex resuming execution
3371 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3372 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3373 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3374 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3375 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3376 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3377 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3378 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3379
3380 @table @code
3381 @kindex continue
3382 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3383 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3384 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3385 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3386 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3387 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3388 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3389 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3390 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3391 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3392
3393 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3394 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3395 @code{continue} is ignored.
3396
3397 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3398 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3399 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3400 @code{continue}.
3401 @end table
3402
3403 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3404 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3405 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3406 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3407
3408 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3409 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3410 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3411 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3412 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3413 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex step
3417 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3418 @item step
3419 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3420 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3421 abbreviated @code{s}.
3422
3423 @quotation
3424 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3425 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3426 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3427 @c distinction here.
3428 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3429 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3430 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3431 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3432 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3433 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3434 below.
3435 @end quotation
3436
3437 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3438 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3439 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3440 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3441 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3442 called within the line.
3443
3444 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3445 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3446 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3447 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3448 was any debugging information about the routine.
3449
3450 @item step @var{count}
3451 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3452 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3453 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3454
3455 @kindex next
3456 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3457 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3458 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3459 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3460 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3461 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3462 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3463 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3464
3465 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3466
3467
3468 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3469 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3470 @c
3471 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3472 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3473 @c function are executed without stopping.
3474
3475 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3476 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3477 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3478
3479 @kindex set step-mode
3480 @item set step-mode
3481 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3482 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3483 @itemx set step-mode on
3484 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3485 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3486 information rather than stepping over it.
3487
3488 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3489 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3490 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3491
3492 @item set step-mode off
3493 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3494 debug information. This is the default.
3495
3496 @kindex finish
3497 @item finish
3498 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3499 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3500
3501 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3502 ,Returning from a function}).
3503
3504 @kindex until
3505 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3506 @item until
3507 @itemx u
3508 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3509 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3510 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3511 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3512 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3513 than the address of the jump.
3514
3515 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3516 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3517 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3518 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3519 through the next iteration.
3520
3521 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3522 stack frame.
3523
3524 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3525 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3526 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3527 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3528 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3529
3530 @smallexample
3531 (@value{GDBP}) f
3532 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3533 206 expand_input();
3534 (@value{GDBP}) until
3535 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3536 @end smallexample
3537
3538 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3539 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3540 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3541 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3542 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3543 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3544 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3545
3546 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3547 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3548 argument.
3549
3550 @item until @var{location}
3551 @itemx u @var{location}
3552 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3553 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3554 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3555 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3556 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3557 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3558 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3559 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3560 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3561 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3562 invocations have returned.
3563
3564 @smallexample
3565 94 int factorial (int value)
3566 95 @{
3567 96 if (value > 1) @{
3568 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3569 98 @}
3570 99 return (value);
3571 100 @}
3572 @end smallexample
3573
3574
3575 @kindex advance @var{location}
3576 @itemx advance @var{location}
3577 Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3578 required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3579 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3580 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3581 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3582 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3583
3584
3585 @kindex stepi
3586 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3587 @item stepi
3588 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3589 @itemx si
3590 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3591
3592 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3593 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3594 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3595 Display,, Automatic display}.
3596
3597 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3598
3599 @need 750
3600 @kindex nexti
3601 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3602 @item nexti
3603 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3604 @itemx ni
3605 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3606 proceed until the function returns.
3607
3608 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3609 @end table
3610
3611 @node Signals
3612 @section Signals
3613 @cindex signals
3614
3615 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3616 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3617 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3618 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3619 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3620 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3621 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3622 requested an alarm).
3623
3624 @cindex fatal signals
3625 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3626 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3627 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3628 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3629 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3630 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3631
3632 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3633 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3634 signal.
3635
3636 @cindex handling signals
3637 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3638 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3639 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3640 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3641 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3642
3643 @table @code
3644 @kindex info signals
3645 @item info signals
3646 @itemx info handle
3647 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3648 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3649 the defined types of signals.
3650
3651 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3652
3653 @kindex handle
3654 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3655 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3656 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3657 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3658 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3659 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @c @group
3663 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3664 Their full names are:
3665
3666 @table @code
3667 @item nostop
3668 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3669 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3670
3671 @item stop
3672 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3673 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3674
3675 @item print
3676 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3677
3678 @item noprint
3679 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3680 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3681
3682 @item pass
3683 @itemx noignore
3684 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3685 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3686 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3687
3688 @item nopass
3689 @itemx ignore
3690 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3691 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3692 @end table
3693 @c @end group
3694
3695 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3696 program until you
3697 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3698 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3699 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3700 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3701 program sees that signal when you continue.
3702
3703 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3704 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3705 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3706 erroneous signals.
3707
3708 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3709 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3710 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3711 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3712 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3713 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3714 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3715 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3716 program a signal}.
3717
3718 @node Thread Stops
3719 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3720
3721 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3722 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3723 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3724
3725 @table @code
3726 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3727 @cindex thread breakpoints
3728 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3729 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3730 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3731 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3732 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3733
3734 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3735 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3736 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3737 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3738 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3739
3740 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3741 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3742 program.
3743
3744 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3745 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3746 breakpoint condition, like this:
3747
3748 @smallexample
3749 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3750 @end smallexample
3751
3752 @end table
3753
3754 @cindex stopped threads
3755 @cindex threads, stopped
3756 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3757 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3758 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3759 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3760 underfoot.
3761
3762 @cindex continuing threads
3763 @cindex threads, continuing
3764 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3765 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3766 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3767
3768 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3769 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3770 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3771 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3772 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3773 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3774 stops.
3775
3776 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3777 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3778 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3779 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3780
3781 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3782 thread to run.
3783
3784 @table @code
3785 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3786 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3787 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3788 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3789 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3790 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3791 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3792 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3793 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3794 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3795 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3796 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3797
3798 @item show scheduler-locking
3799 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3800 @end table
3801
3802
3803 @node Stack
3804 @chapter Examining the Stack
3805
3806 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3807 stopped and how it got there.
3808
3809 @cindex call stack
3810 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3811 is generated.
3812 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3813 the arguments of the call,
3814 and the local variables of the function being called.
3815 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3816 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3817 stack}.
3818
3819 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3820 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3821
3822 @cindex selected frame
3823 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3824 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3825 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3826 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3827 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3828 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3829
3830 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3831 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3832 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3833
3834 @menu
3835 * Frames:: Stack frames
3836 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3837 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3838 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3839
3840 @end menu
3841
3842 @node Frames
3843 @section Stack frames
3844
3845 @cindex frame, definition
3846 @cindex stack frame
3847 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3848 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3849 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3850 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3851 which the function is executing.
3852
3853 @cindex initial frame
3854 @cindex outermost frame
3855 @cindex innermost frame
3856 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3857 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3858 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3859 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3860 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3861 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3862 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3863 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3864
3865 @cindex frame pointer
3866 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3867 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3868 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3869 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3870 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3871 going on in that frame.
3872
3873 @cindex frame number
3874 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3875 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3876 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3877 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3878 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3879
3880 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3881 @c underflow problems.
3882 @cindex frameless execution
3883 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3884 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3885 @smallexample
3886 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3887 @end smallexample
3888 generates functions without a frame.)
3889 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3890 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3891 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3892 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3893 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3894 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3895 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3896
3897 @table @code
3898 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3899 @cindex current stack frame
3900 @item frame @var{args}
3901 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3902 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3903 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3904 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3905
3906 @kindex select-frame
3907 @cindex selecting frame silently
3908 @item select-frame
3909 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3910 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3911 @code{frame}.
3912 @end table
3913
3914 @node Backtrace
3915 @section Backtraces
3916
3917 @cindex backtraces
3918 @cindex tracebacks
3919 @cindex stack traces
3920 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3921 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3922 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3923 stack.
3924
3925 @table @code
3926 @kindex backtrace
3927 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3928 @item backtrace
3929 @itemx bt
3930 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3931 frames in the stack.
3932
3933 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3934 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3935
3936 @item backtrace @var{n}
3937 @itemx bt @var{n}
3938 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3939
3940 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3941 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3942 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3943 @end table
3944
3945 @kindex where
3946 @kindex info stack
3947 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3948 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3949 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3950
3951 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3952 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3953 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3954 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3955 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3956 line number.
3957
3958 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3959 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3960
3961 @smallexample
3962 @group
3963 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3964 at builtin.c:993
3965 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3966 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3967 at macro.c:71
3968 (More stack frames follow...)
3969 @end group
3970 @end smallexample
3971
3972 @noindent
3973 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3974 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3975 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3976
3977 @kindex set backtrace past-main
3978 @kindex show backtrace past-main
3979 @kindex set backtrace limit
3980 @kindex show backtrace limit
3981
3982 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
3983 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
3984 @code{main}. When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
3985 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
3986 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
3987
3988 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
3989 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
3990
3991 @table @code
3992 @item set backtrace past-main
3993 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
3994 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
3995
3996 @item set backtrace past-main off
3997 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3998 default.
3999
4000 @item show backtrace past-main
4001 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4002
4003 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4004 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4005 @cindex backtrace limit
4006 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4007 unlimited.
4008
4009 @item show backtrace limit
4010 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4011 @end table
4012
4013 @node Selection
4014 @section Selecting a frame
4015
4016 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4017 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4018 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4019 of the stack frame just selected.
4020
4021 @table @code
4022 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4023 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4024 @item frame @var{n}
4025 @itemx f @var{n}
4026 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4027 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4028 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4029 @code{main}.
4030
4031 @item frame @var{addr}
4032 @itemx f @var{addr}
4033 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4034 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4035 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4036 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4037 switches between them.
4038
4039 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4040 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4041
4042 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4043 pointer and a program counter.
4044
4045 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4046 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4047 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
4048 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
4049 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
4050
4051 @kindex up
4052 @item up @var{n}
4053 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4054 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4055 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4056
4057 @kindex down
4058 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4059 @item down @var{n}
4060 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4061 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4062 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4063 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4064 @end table
4065
4066 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4067 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4068 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4069 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4070
4071 @need 1000
4072 For example:
4073
4074 @smallexample
4075 @group
4076 (@value{GDBP}) up
4077 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4078 at env.c:10
4079 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4080 @end group
4081 @end smallexample
4082
4083 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4084 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4085 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4086 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4087 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4088 for details.
4089
4090 @table @code
4091 @kindex down-silently
4092 @kindex up-silently
4093 @item up-silently @var{n}
4094 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4095 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4096 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4097 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4098 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4099 distracting.
4100 @end table
4101
4102 @node Frame Info
4103 @section Information about a frame
4104
4105 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4106 stack frame.
4107
4108 @table @code
4109 @item frame
4110 @itemx f
4111 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4112 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4113 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4114 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4115 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4116
4117 @kindex info frame
4118 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4119 @item info frame
4120 @itemx info f
4121 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4122 including:
4123
4124 @itemize @bullet
4125 @item
4126 the address of the frame
4127 @item
4128 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4129 @item
4130 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4131 @item
4132 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4133 @item
4134 the address of the frame's arguments
4135 @item
4136 the address of the frame's local variables
4137 @item
4138 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4139 @item
4140 which registers were saved in the frame
4141 @end itemize
4142
4143 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4144 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4145 the usual conventions.
4146
4147 @item info frame @var{addr}
4148 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4149 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4150 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4151 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4152 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4153 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4154
4155 @kindex info args
4156 @item info args
4157 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4158
4159 @item info locals
4160 @kindex info locals
4161 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4162 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4163 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4164
4165 @kindex info catch
4166 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4167 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4168 @item info catch
4169 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4170 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4171 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4172 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4173 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4174
4175 @end table
4176
4177
4178 @node Source
4179 @chapter Examining Source Files
4180
4181 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4182 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4183 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4184 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4185 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4186 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4187 source files by explicit command.
4188
4189 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4190 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4191 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4192
4193 @menu
4194 * List:: Printing source lines
4195 * Edit:: Editing source files
4196 * Search:: Searching source files
4197 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4198 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4199 @end menu
4200
4201 @node List
4202 @section Printing source lines
4203
4204 @kindex list
4205 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4206 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4207 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4208 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4209
4210 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4211
4212 @table @code
4213 @item list @var{linenum}
4214 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4215 current source file.
4216
4217 @item list @var{function}
4218 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4219 @var{function}.
4220
4221 @item list
4222 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4223 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4224 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4225 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4226 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4227
4228 @item list -
4229 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4230 @end table
4231
4232 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4233 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4234
4235 @table @code
4236 @kindex set listsize
4237 @item set listsize @var{count}
4238 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4239 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4240
4241 @kindex show listsize
4242 @item show listsize
4243 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4244 @end table
4245
4246 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4247 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4248 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4249 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4250 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4251
4252 @cindex linespec
4253 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4254 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4255 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4256 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4257
4258 @table @code
4259 @item list @var{linespec}
4260 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4261
4262 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4263 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4264 linespecs.
4265
4266 @item list ,@var{last}
4267 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4268
4269 @item list @var{first},
4270 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4271
4272 @item list +
4273 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4274
4275 @item list -
4276 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4277
4278 @item list
4279 As described in the preceding table.
4280 @end table
4281
4282 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4283 kinds of linespec.
4284
4285 @table @code
4286 @item @var{number}
4287 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4288 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4289 the same source file as the first linespec.
4290
4291 @item +@var{offset}
4292 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4293 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4294 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4295 first linespec.
4296
4297 @item -@var{offset}
4298 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4299
4300 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4301 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4302
4303 @item @var{function}
4304 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4305 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4306
4307 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4308 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4309 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4310 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4311 identically named functions in different source files.
4312
4313 @item *@var{address}
4314 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4315 @var{address} may be any expression.
4316 @end table
4317
4318 @node Edit
4319 @section Editing source files
4320 @cindex editing source files
4321
4322 @kindex edit
4323 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4324 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4325 The editing program of your choice
4326 is invoked with the current line set to
4327 the active line in the program.
4328 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4329 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4330
4331 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4332
4333 @table @code
4334 @item edit
4335 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4336
4337 @item edit @var{number}
4338 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4339
4340 @item edit @var{function}
4341 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4342
4343 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4344 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4345
4346 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4347 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4348 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4349 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4350 identically named functions in different source files.
4351
4352 @item edit *@var{address}
4353 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4354 @var{address} may be any expression.
4355 @end table
4356
4357 @subsection Choosing your editor
4358 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4359 @footnote{
4360 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4361 following command-line syntax:
4362 @smallexample
4363 ex +@var{number} file
4364 @end smallexample
4365 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4366 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4367 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4368 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4369 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4370 @smallexample
4371 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4372 export EDITOR
4373 gdb ...
4374 @end smallexample
4375 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4376 @smallexample
4377 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4378 gdb ...
4379 @end smallexample
4380
4381 @node Search
4382 @section Searching source files
4383 @cindex searching
4384 @kindex reverse-search
4385
4386 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4387 regular expression.
4388
4389 @table @code
4390 @kindex search
4391 @kindex forward-search
4392 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4393 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4394 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4395 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4396 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4397 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4398 @code{fo}.
4399
4400 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4401 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4402 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4403 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4404 this command as @code{rev}.
4405 @end table
4406
4407 @node Source Path
4408 @section Specifying source directories
4409
4410 @cindex source path
4411 @cindex directories for source files
4412 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4413 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4414 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4415 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4416 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4417 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4418 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4419 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4420 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4421 path.
4422
4423 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4424 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4425 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4426 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4427 last resort.
4428
4429 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4430 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4431 each line is in the file.
4432
4433 @kindex directory
4434 @kindex dir
4435 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4436 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4437 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4438
4439 @table @code
4440 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4441 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4442 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4443 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4444 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4445 part of absolute file names) or
4446 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4447 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4448
4449 @kindex cdir
4450 @kindex cwd
4451 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4452 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4453 @cindex compilation directory
4454 @cindex current directory
4455 @cindex working directory
4456 @cindex directory, current
4457 @cindex directory, compilation
4458 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4459 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4460 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4461 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4462 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4463 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4464
4465 @item directory
4466 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4467
4468 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4469 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4470
4471 @item show directories
4472 @kindex show directories
4473 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4474 @end table
4475
4476 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4477 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4478 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4479
4480 @enumerate
4481 @item
4482 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4483
4484 @item
4485 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4486 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4487 directories in one command.
4488 @end enumerate
4489
4490 @node Machine Code
4491 @section Source and machine code
4492
4493 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4494 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4495 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4496 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4497 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4498 well as hex.
4499
4500 @table @code
4501 @kindex info line
4502 @item info line @var{linespec}
4503 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4504 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4505 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4506 source lines}).
4507 @end table
4508
4509 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4510 the object code for the first line of function
4511 @code{m4_changequote}:
4512
4513 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4514 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4515 @smallexample
4516 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4517 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4518 @end smallexample
4519
4520 @noindent
4521 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4522 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4523 @smallexample
4524 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4525 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4526 @end smallexample
4527
4528 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4529 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4530 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4531 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4532 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4533 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4534 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4535 variables}).
4536
4537 @table @code
4538 @kindex disassemble
4539 @cindex assembly instructions
4540 @cindex instructions, assembly
4541 @cindex machine instructions
4542 @cindex listing machine instructions
4543 @item disassemble
4544 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4545 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4546 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4547 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4548 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4549 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4550 @end table
4551
4552 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4553 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4554
4555 @smallexample
4556 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4557 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4558 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4559 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4560 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4561 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4562 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4563 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4564 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4565 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4566 End of assembler dump.
4567 @end smallexample
4568
4569 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4570 mnemonics or other syntax.
4571
4572 @table @code
4573 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4574 @cindex assembly instructions
4575 @cindex instructions, assembly
4576 @cindex machine instructions
4577 @cindex listing machine instructions
4578 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4579 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4580 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4581 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4582 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4583
4584 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4585 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4586 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4587 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4588 @end table
4589
4590
4591 @node Data
4592 @chapter Examining Data
4593
4594 @cindex printing data
4595 @cindex examining data
4596 @kindex print
4597 @kindex inspect
4598 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4599 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4600 @c different window or something like that.
4601 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4602 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4603 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4604 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4605 Different Languages}).
4606
4607 @table @code
4608 @item print @var{expr}
4609 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4610 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4611 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4612 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4613 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4614 formats}.
4615
4616 @item print
4617 @itemx print /@var{f}
4618 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4619 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4620 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4621 @end table
4622
4623 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4624 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4625 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4626
4627 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4628 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4629 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4630 Table}.
4631
4632 @menu
4633 * Expressions:: Expressions
4634 * Variables:: Program variables
4635 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4636 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4637 * Memory:: Examining memory
4638 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4639 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4640 * Value History:: Value history
4641 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4642 * Registers:: Registers
4643 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4644 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4645 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4646 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4647 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4648 character set than GDB does
4649 @end menu
4650
4651 @node Expressions
4652 @section Expressions
4653
4654 @cindex expressions
4655 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4656 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4657 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4658 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4659 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4660 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4661 @ref{Compilation}.
4662
4663 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4664 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4665 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4666 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4667
4668 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4669 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4670 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4671 languages.
4672
4673 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4674 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4675
4676 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4677 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4678 at that address in memory.
4679 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4680
4681 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4682 to programming languages:
4683
4684 @table @code
4685 @item @@
4686 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4687 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4688
4689 @item ::
4690 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4691 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4692
4693 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4694 @cindex type casting memory
4695 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4696 @cindex casts, to view memory
4697 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4698 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4699 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4700 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4701 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4702 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4703 @end table
4704
4705 @node Variables
4706 @section Program variables
4707
4708 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4709 in your program.
4710
4711 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4712 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4713
4714 @itemize @bullet
4715 @item
4716 global (or file-static)
4717 @end itemize
4718
4719 @noindent or
4720
4721 @itemize @bullet
4722 @item
4723 visible according to the scope rules of the
4724 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4725 @end itemize
4726
4727 @noindent This means that in the function
4728
4729 @smallexample
4730 foo (a)
4731 int a;
4732 @{
4733 bar (a);
4734 @{
4735 int b = test ();
4736 bar (b);
4737 @}
4738 @}
4739 @end smallexample
4740
4741 @noindent
4742 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4743 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4744 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4745 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4746
4747 @cindex variable name conflict
4748 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4749 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4750 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4751 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4752 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4753 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4754 using the colon-colon notation:
4755
4756 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4757 @iftex
4758 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4759 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4760 @end iftex
4761 @smallexample
4762 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4763 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4764 @end smallexample
4765
4766 @noindent
4767 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4768 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4769 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4770 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4771
4772 @smallexample
4773 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4774 @end smallexample
4775
4776 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4777 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4778 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4779 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4780 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4781 @c conflict?? --mew
4782
4783 @cindex wrong values
4784 @cindex variable values, wrong
4785 @quotation
4786 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4787 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4788 scope, and just before exit.
4789 @end quotation
4790 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4791 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4792 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4793 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4794 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4795 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4796 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4797 variable definitions may be gone.
4798
4799 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4800 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4801 when compiling.
4802
4803 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4804 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4805 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4806 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4807 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4808 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4809 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4810
4811 @smallexample
4812 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4813 @end smallexample
4814
4815 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4816 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4817 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4818 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4819 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4820 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4821 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4822 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
4823
4824
4825 @node Arrays
4826 @section Artificial arrays
4827
4828 @cindex artificial array
4829 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4830 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4831 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4832 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4833 program.
4834
4835 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4836 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4837 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4838 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4839 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4840 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4841 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4842 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4843 example. If a program says
4844
4845 @smallexample
4846 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4847 @end smallexample
4848
4849 @noindent
4850 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4851
4852 @smallexample
4853 p *array@@len
4854 @end smallexample
4855
4856 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4857 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4858 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4859 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4860 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4861
4862 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4863 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4864 The value need not be in memory:
4865 @smallexample
4866 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4867 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4868 @end smallexample
4869
4870 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4871 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4872 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4873 @smallexample
4874 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4875 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4876 @end smallexample
4877
4878 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4879 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4880 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4881 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4882 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4883 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4884 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4885 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4886 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4887 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4888
4889 @smallexample
4890 set $i = 0
4891 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4892 @key{RET}
4893 @key{RET}
4894 @dots{}
4895 @end smallexample
4896
4897 @node Output Formats
4898 @section Output formats
4899
4900 @cindex formatted output
4901 @cindex output formats
4902 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4903 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4904 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4905 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4906 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4907
4908 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4909 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4910 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4911 letters supported are:
4912
4913 @table @code
4914 @item x
4915 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4916 hexadecimal.
4917
4918 @item d
4919 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4920
4921 @item u
4922 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4923
4924 @item o
4925 Print as integer in octal.
4926
4927 @item t
4928 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4929 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4930 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4931 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4932
4933 @item a
4934 @cindex unknown address, locating
4935 @cindex locate address
4936 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4937 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4938 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4939
4940 @smallexample
4941 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4942 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4943 @end smallexample
4944
4945 @noindent
4946 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4947 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4948
4949 @item c
4950 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4951
4952 @item f
4953 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4954 using typical floating point syntax.
4955 @end table
4956
4957 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4958
4959 @smallexample
4960 p/x $pc
4961 @end smallexample
4962
4963 @noindent
4964 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4965 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4966
4967 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4968 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4969 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4970
4971 @node Memory
4972 @section Examining memory
4973
4974 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4975 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4976
4977 @cindex examining memory
4978 @table @code
4979 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4980 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4981 @itemx x @var{addr}
4982 @itemx x
4983 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4984 @end table
4985
4986 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4987 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4988 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4989 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4990 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4991
4992 @table @r
4993 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4994 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4995 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4996 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4997 @c 4.1.2.
4998
4999 @item @var{f}, the display format
5000 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
5001 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
5002 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
5003 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5004
5005 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5006 The unit size is any of
5007
5008 @table @code
5009 @item b
5010 Bytes.
5011 @item h
5012 Halfwords (two bytes).
5013 @item w
5014 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5015 @item g
5016 Giant words (eight bytes).
5017 @end table
5018
5019 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5020 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5021 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5022
5023 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5024 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5025 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5026 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5027 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5028 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5029 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5030 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5031 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5032 a value from memory).
5033 @end table
5034
5035 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5036 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5037 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5038 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5039 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5040
5041 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5042 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5043 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5044 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5045 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5046
5047 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5048 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5049 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5050 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5051 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5052 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5053
5054 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5055 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5056 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5057 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5058 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5059 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5060 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5061
5062 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5063 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5064 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5065 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5066 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5067 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5068 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5069 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5070 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5071
5072 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5073 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5074 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5075
5076 @node Auto Display
5077 @section Automatic display
5078 @cindex automatic display
5079 @cindex display of expressions
5080
5081 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5082 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5083 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5084 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5085 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5086 The automatic display looks like this:
5087
5088 @smallexample
5089 2: foo = 38
5090 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5091 @end smallexample
5092
5093 @noindent
5094 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5095 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5096 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5097 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5098 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5099 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5100 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5101
5102 @table @code
5103 @kindex display
5104 @item display @var{expr}
5105 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5106 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5107
5108 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5109
5110 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5111 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5112 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5113 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5114 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5115
5116 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5117 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5118 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5119 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5120 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5121 @end table
5122
5123 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5124 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5125 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5126
5127 @table @code
5128 @kindex delete display
5129 @kindex undisplay
5130 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5131 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5132 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5133
5134 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5135 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5136
5137 @kindex disable display
5138 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5139 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5140 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5141 enabled again later.
5142
5143 @kindex enable display
5144 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5145 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5146 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5147
5148 @item display
5149 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5150 done when your program stops.
5151
5152 @kindex info display
5153 @item info display
5154 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5155 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5156 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5157 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5158 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5159 @end table
5160
5161 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5162 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5163 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5164 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5165 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5166 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5167 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5168 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5169 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5170 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5171
5172 @node Print Settings
5173 @section Print settings
5174
5175 @cindex format options
5176 @cindex print settings
5177 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5178 and symbols are printed.
5179
5180 @noindent
5181 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5182
5183 @table @code
5184 @kindex set print address
5185 @item set print address
5186 @itemx set print address on
5187 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5188 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5189 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5190 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5191 @code{set print address on}:
5192
5193 @smallexample
5194 @group
5195 (@value{GDBP}) f
5196 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5197 at input.c:530
5198 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5199 @end group
5200 @end smallexample
5201
5202 @item set print address off
5203 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5204 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5205
5206 @smallexample
5207 @group
5208 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5209 (@value{GDBP}) f
5210 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5211 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5212 @end group
5213 @end smallexample
5214
5215 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5216 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5217 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5218 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5219
5220 @kindex show print address
5221 @item show print address
5222 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5223 @end table
5224
5225 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5226 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5227 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5228 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5229 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5230 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5231 it prints a symbolic address:
5232
5233 @table @code
5234 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5235 @item set print symbol-filename on
5236 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5237 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5238
5239 @item set print symbol-filename off
5240 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5241 default.
5242
5243 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5244 @item show print symbol-filename
5245 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5246 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5247 @end table
5248
5249 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5250 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5251 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5252
5253 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5254 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5255
5256 @table @code
5257 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5258 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5259 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5260 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5261 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5262 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5263
5264 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5265 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5266 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5267 symbolic address.
5268 @end table
5269
5270 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5271 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5272 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5273 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5274 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5275 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5276 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5277 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5278
5279 @smallexample
5280 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5281 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5282 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5283 @end smallexample
5284
5285 @quotation
5286 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5287 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5288 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5289 @end quotation
5290
5291 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5292
5293 @table @code
5294 @kindex set print array
5295 @item set print array
5296 @itemx set print array on
5297 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5298 but uses more space. The default is off.
5299
5300 @item set print array off
5301 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5302
5303 @kindex show print array
5304 @item show print array
5305 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5306 arrays.
5307
5308 @kindex set print elements
5309 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5310 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5311 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5312 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5313 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5314 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5315 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5316
5317 @kindex show print elements
5318 @item show print elements
5319 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5320 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5321
5322 @kindex set print null-stop
5323 @item set print null-stop
5324 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5325 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5326 contain only short strings.
5327 The default is off.
5328
5329 @kindex set print pretty
5330 @item set print pretty on
5331 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5332 per line, like this:
5333
5334 @smallexample
5335 @group
5336 $1 = @{
5337 next = 0x0,
5338 flags = @{
5339 sweet = 1,
5340 sour = 1
5341 @},
5342 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5343 @}
5344 @end group
5345 @end smallexample
5346
5347 @item set print pretty off
5348 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5349
5350 @smallexample
5351 @group
5352 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5353 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5354 @end group
5355 @end smallexample
5356
5357 @noindent
5358 This is the default format.
5359
5360 @kindex show print pretty
5361 @item show print pretty
5362 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5363
5364 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5365 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5366 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5367 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5368 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5369 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5370 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5371
5372 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5373 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5374 international character sets, and is the default.
5375
5376 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5377 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5378 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5379
5380 @kindex set print union
5381 @item set print union on
5382 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5383 is the default setting.
5384
5385 @item set print union off
5386 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5387
5388 @kindex show print union
5389 @item show print union
5390 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5391 structures.
5392
5393 For example, given the declarations
5394
5395 @smallexample
5396 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5397 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5398 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5399 Bug_forms;
5400
5401 struct thing @{
5402 Species it;
5403 union @{
5404 Tree_forms tree;
5405 Bug_forms bug;
5406 @} form;
5407 @};
5408
5409 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5410 @end smallexample
5411
5412 @noindent
5413 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5414
5415 @smallexample
5416 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5417 @end smallexample
5418
5419 @noindent
5420 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5421
5422 @smallexample
5423 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5424 @end smallexample
5425 @end table
5426
5427 @need 1000
5428 @noindent
5429 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5430
5431 @table @code
5432 @cindex demangling
5433 @kindex set print demangle
5434 @item set print demangle
5435 @itemx set print demangle on
5436 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5437 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5438 linkage. The default is on.
5439
5440 @kindex show print demangle
5441 @item show print demangle
5442 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5443
5444 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5445 @item set print asm-demangle
5446 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5447 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5448 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5449 The default is off.
5450
5451 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5452 @item show print asm-demangle
5453 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5454 or demangled form.
5455
5456 @kindex set demangle-style
5457 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5458 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5459 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5460 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5461 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5462
5463 @table @code
5464 @item auto
5465 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5466
5467 @item gnu
5468 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5469 This is the default.
5470
5471 @item hp
5472 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5473
5474 @item lucid
5475 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5476
5477 @item arm
5478 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5479 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5480 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5481 require further enhancement to permit that.
5482
5483 @end table
5484 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5485
5486 @kindex show demangle-style
5487 @item show demangle-style
5488 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5489
5490 @kindex set print object
5491 @item set print object
5492 @itemx set print object on
5493 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5494 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5495 the virtual function table.
5496
5497 @item set print object off
5498 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5499 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5500
5501 @kindex show print object
5502 @item show print object
5503 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5504
5505 @kindex set print static-members
5506 @item set print static-members
5507 @itemx set print static-members on
5508 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5509
5510 @item set print static-members off
5511 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5512
5513 @kindex show print static-members
5514 @item show print static-members
5515 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5516
5517 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5518 @kindex set print vtbl
5519 @item set print vtbl
5520 @itemx set print vtbl on
5521 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5522 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5523 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5524
5525 @item set print vtbl off
5526 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5527
5528 @kindex show print vtbl
5529 @item show print vtbl
5530 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5531 @end table
5532
5533 @node Value History
5534 @section Value history
5535
5536 @cindex value history
5537 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5538 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5539 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5540 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5541 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5542 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5543 symbol table.
5544
5545 @cindex @code{$}
5546 @cindex @code{$$}
5547 @cindex history number
5548 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5549 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5550 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5551 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5552 history number.
5553
5554 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5555 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5556 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5557 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5558 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5559 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5560 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5561
5562 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5563 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5564
5565 @smallexample
5566 p *$
5567 @end smallexample
5568
5569 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5570 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5571
5572 @smallexample
5573 p *$.next
5574 @end smallexample
5575
5576 @noindent
5577 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5578 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5579
5580 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5581 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5582
5583 @smallexample
5584 print x
5585 set x=5
5586 @end smallexample
5587
5588 @noindent
5589 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5590 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5591
5592 @table @code
5593 @kindex show values
5594 @item show values
5595 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5596 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5597 values} does not change the history.
5598
5599 @item show values @var{n}
5600 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5601
5602 @item show values +
5603 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5604 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5605 @end table
5606
5607 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5608 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5609
5610 @node Convenience Vars
5611 @section Convenience variables
5612
5613 @cindex convenience variables
5614 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5615 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5616 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5617 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5618 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5619
5620 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5621 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5622 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5623 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5624 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5625
5626 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5627 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5628 For example:
5629
5630 @smallexample
5631 set $foo = *object_ptr
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 @noindent
5635 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5636 @code{object_ptr}.
5637
5638 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5639 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5640 value with another assignment at any time.
5641
5642 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5643 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5644 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5645 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5646
5647 @table @code
5648 @kindex show convenience
5649 @item show convenience
5650 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5651 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5652 @end table
5653
5654 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5655 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5656 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5657
5658 @smallexample
5659 set $i = 0
5660 print bar[$i++]->contents
5661 @end smallexample
5662
5663 @noindent
5664 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5665
5666 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5667 values likely to be useful.
5668
5669 @table @code
5670 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5671 @item $_
5672 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5673 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5674 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5675 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5676 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5677 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5678 to the type of @code{$__}.
5679
5680 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5681 @item $__
5682 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5683 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5684 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5685
5686 @item $_exitcode
5687 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5688 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5689 the program being debugged terminates.
5690 @end table
5691
5692 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5693 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5694 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5695
5696 @node Registers
5697 @section Registers
5698
5699 @cindex registers
5700 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5701 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5702 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5703 your machine.
5704
5705 @table @code
5706 @kindex info registers
5707 @item info registers
5708 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5709 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5710
5711 @kindex info all-registers
5712 @cindex floating point registers
5713 @item info all-registers
5714 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5715 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5716
5717 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5718 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5719 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5720 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5721 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5722 @end table
5723
5724 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5725 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5726 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5727 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5728 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5729 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5730 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5731 you could print the program counter in hex with
5732
5733 @smallexample
5734 p/x $pc
5735 @end smallexample
5736
5737 @noindent
5738 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5739
5740 @smallexample
5741 x/i $pc
5742 @end smallexample
5743
5744 @noindent
5745 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5746 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5747 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5748 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5749 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5750 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5751 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5752
5753 @smallexample
5754 set $sp += 4
5755 @end smallexample
5756
5757 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5758 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5759 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5760 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5761 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5762 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5763 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5764
5765 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5766 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5767 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5768 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5769 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5770 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5771 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5772
5773 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5774 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5775 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5776 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5777 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5778 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5779 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5780 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5781 prints the data in both formats.
5782
5783 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5784 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5785 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5786 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5787 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5788 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5789
5790 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5791 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5792 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5793 frame makes no difference.
5794
5795 @node Floating Point Hardware
5796 @section Floating point hardware
5797 @cindex floating point
5798
5799 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5800 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5801
5802 @table @code
5803 @kindex info float
5804 @item info float
5805 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5806 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5807 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5808 the ARM and x86 machines.
5809 @end table
5810
5811 @node Vector Unit
5812 @section Vector Unit
5813 @cindex vector unit
5814
5815 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5816 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5817
5818 @table @code
5819 @kindex info vector
5820 @item info vector
5821 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5822 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5823 @end table
5824
5825 @node Memory Region Attributes
5826 @section Memory region attributes
5827 @cindex memory region attributes
5828
5829 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5830 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5831 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5832 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5833
5834 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5835 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5836 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5837 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5838 all memory.
5839
5840 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5841 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5842
5843 @table @code
5844 @kindex mem
5845 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5846 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5847 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5848 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5849 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5850
5851 @kindex delete mem
5852 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5853 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5854
5855 @kindex disable mem
5856 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5857 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5858 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5859 It may be enabled again later.
5860
5861 @kindex enable mem
5862 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5863 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5864
5865 @kindex info mem
5866 @item info mem
5867 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5868 for each region.
5869
5870 @table @emph
5871 @item Memory Region Number
5872 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5873 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5874 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5875
5876 @item Lo Address
5877 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5878
5879 @item Hi Address
5880 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5881
5882 @item Attributes
5883 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5884 @end table
5885 @end table
5886
5887
5888 @subsection Attributes
5889
5890 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5891 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5892 write accesses to a memory region.
5893
5894 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5895 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5896 etc. from accessing memory.
5897
5898 @table @code
5899 @item ro
5900 Memory is read only.
5901 @item wo
5902 Memory is write only.
5903 @item rw
5904 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5905 @end table
5906
5907 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5908 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5909 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5910 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5911 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5912
5913 @table @code
5914 @item 8
5915 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5916 @item 16
5917 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5918 @item 32
5919 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5920 @item 64
5921 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5922 @end table
5923
5924 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5925 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5926 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5927 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5928 @c
5929 @c @table @code
5930 @c @item hwbreak
5931 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5932 @c @item swbreak (default)
5933 @c @end table
5934
5935 @subsubsection Data Cache
5936 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5937 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5938 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5939 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5940 registers.
5941
5942 @table @code
5943 @item cache
5944 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5945 @item nocache
5946 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5947 @end table
5948
5949 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5950 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5951 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5952 @c
5953 @c @table @code
5954 @c @item verify
5955 @c @item noverify (default)
5956 @c @end table
5957
5958 @node Dump/Restore Files
5959 @section Copy between memory and a file
5960 @cindex dump/restore files
5961 @cindex append data to a file
5962 @cindex dump data to a file
5963 @cindex restore data from a file
5964
5965 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
5966 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
5967 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
5968 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
5969 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
5970 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
5971 files.
5972
5973 @table @code
5974
5975 @kindex dump
5976 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5977 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
5978 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
5979 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
5980
5981 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
5982 @table @code
5983 @item binary
5984 Raw binary form.
5985 @item ihex
5986 Intel hex format.
5987 @item srec
5988 Motorola S-record format.
5989 @item tekhex
5990 Tektronix Hex format.
5991 @end table
5992
5993 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
5994 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
5995 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
5996 form.
5997
5998 @kindex append
5999 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6000 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6001 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6002 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6003 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6004
6005 @kindex restore
6006 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6007 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6008 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6009 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6010 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6011
6012 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6013 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6014 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6015 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6016 from that location.
6017
6018 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6019 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6020 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6021 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6022
6023 @end table
6024
6025 @node Character Sets
6026 @section Character Sets
6027 @cindex character sets
6028 @cindex charset
6029 @cindex translating between character sets
6030 @cindex host character set
6031 @cindex target character set
6032
6033 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6034 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6035 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6036 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6037 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6038 @dfn{target character set}.
6039
6040 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6041 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6042 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6043 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6044 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6045 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6046 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6047 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6048 character and string literals in expressions.
6049
6050 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6051 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6052 target-charset} command, described below.
6053
6054 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6055 support:
6056
6057 @table @code
6058 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6059 @kindex set target-charset
6060 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6061 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6062 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6063 list the target character sets it supports.
6064 @end table
6065
6066 @table @code
6067 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6068 @kindex set host-charset
6069 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6070
6071 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6072 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6073 @code{set host-charset} command.
6074
6075 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6076 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6077 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6078 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6079 list the host character sets it supports.
6080
6081 @item set charset @var{charset}
6082 @kindex set charset
6083 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6084 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6085 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6086 for both host and target.
6087
6088
6089 @item show charset
6090 @kindex show charset
6091 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6092
6093 @itemx show host-charset
6094 @kindex show host-charset
6095 Show the name of the current host charset.
6096
6097 @itemx show target-charset
6098 @kindex show target-charset
6099 Show the name of the current target charset.
6100
6101 @end table
6102
6103 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6104 sets:
6105
6106 @table @code
6107
6108 @item ASCII
6109 @cindex ASCII character set
6110 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6111 character set.
6112
6113 @item ISO-8859-1
6114 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6115 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6116 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6117 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6118 this as its host character set.
6119
6120 @item EBCDIC-US
6121 @itemx IBM1047
6122 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6123 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6124 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6125 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6126 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6127
6128 @end table
6129
6130 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6131 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6132 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6133
6134 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6135 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6136 @file{charset-test.c}:
6137
6138 @smallexample
6139 #include <stdio.h>
6140
6141 char ascii_hello[]
6142 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6143 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6144 char ibm1047_hello[]
6145 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6146 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6147
6148 main ()
6149 @{
6150 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6151 @}
6152 @end smallexample
6153
6154 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6155 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6156 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6157
6158 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6159
6160 @smallexample
6161 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6162 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6163 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6164 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6165 @dots{}
6166 (gdb)
6167 @end smallexample
6168
6169 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6170 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6171 strings:
6172
6173 @smallexample
6174 (gdb) show charset
6175 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6176 (gdb)
6177 @end smallexample
6178
6179 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6180 initial character set:
6181 @smallexample
6182 (gdb) set charset ASCII
6183 (gdb) show charset
6184 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6185 (gdb)
6186 @end smallexample
6187
6188 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6189 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6190 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6191 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6192 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6193
6194 @smallexample
6195 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6196 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6197 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6198 $2 = 72 'H'
6199 (gdb)
6200 @end smallexample
6201
6202 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6203 literals you use in expressions:
6204
6205 @smallexample
6206 (gdb) print '+'
6207 $3 = 43 '+'
6208 (gdb)
6209 @end smallexample
6210
6211 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6212 character.
6213
6214 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6215 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6216 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6217
6218 @smallexample
6219 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6220 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6221 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6222 $5 = 200 '\310'
6223 (gdb)
6224 @end smallexample
6225
6226 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6227 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6228
6229 @smallexample
6230 (gdb) set target-charset
6231 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6232 (gdb) set target-charset
6233 @end smallexample
6234
6235 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6236 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6237 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6238 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6239 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6240
6241 @smallexample
6242 (gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
6243 (gdb) show charset
6244 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6245 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
6246 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6247 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6248 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6249 $7 = 72 '\110'
6250 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6251 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6252 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6253 $9 = 200 'H'
6254 (gdb)
6255 @end smallexample
6256
6257 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6258 string literals you use in expressions:
6259
6260 @smallexample
6261 (gdb) print '+'
6262 $10 = 78 '+'
6263 (gdb)
6264 @end smallexample
6265
6266 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6267 character.
6268
6269
6270 @node Macros
6271 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6272
6273 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6274 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6275 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6276 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6277 where it was defined.
6278
6279 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6280 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6281 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6282 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6283
6284 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6285 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6286 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6287 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6288 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6289 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6290 see @ref{List}.
6291
6292 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6293 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6294 variable-arity macros.
6295
6296 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6297 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6298 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6299
6300 @table @code
6301
6302 @kindex macro expand
6303 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6304 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6305 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6306 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6307 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6308 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6309 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6310 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6311 it can be any string of tokens.
6312
6313 @kindex macro expand-once
6314 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6315 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6316 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6317 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6318 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6319 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6320 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6321 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6322 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6323 can be any string of tokens.
6324
6325 @kindex info macro
6326 @cindex macro definition, showing
6327 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6328 @item info macro @var{macro}
6329 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6330 source location where that definition was established.
6331
6332 @kindex macro define
6333 @cindex user-defined macros
6334 @cindex defining macros interactively
6335 @cindex macros, user-defined
6336 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6337 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6338 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6339 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6340 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6341 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6342 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6343 given in @var{arglist}.
6344
6345 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6346 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6347 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6348 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6349 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6350
6351 @kindex macro undef
6352 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6353 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6354 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6355 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6356 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6357 debugged.
6358
6359 @end table
6360
6361 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6362 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6363 show our source files:
6364
6365 @smallexample
6366 $ cat sample.c
6367 #include <stdio.h>
6368 #include "sample.h"
6369
6370 #define M 42
6371 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6372
6373 main ()
6374 @{
6375 #define N 28
6376 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6377 #undef N
6378 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6379 #define N 1729
6380 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6381 @}
6382 $ cat sample.h
6383 #define Q <
6384 $
6385 @end smallexample
6386
6387 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6388 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6389 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6390 information.
6391
6392 @smallexample
6393 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6394 $
6395 @end smallexample
6396
6397 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6398
6399 @smallexample
6400 $ gdb -nw sample
6401 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6402 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6403 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6404 (gdb)
6405 @end smallexample
6406
6407 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6408 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6409 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6410
6411 @smallexample
6412 (gdb) list main
6413 3
6414 4 #define M 42
6415 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6416 6
6417 7 main ()
6418 8 @{
6419 9 #define N 28
6420 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6421 11 #undef N
6422 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6423 (gdb) info macro ADD
6424 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6425 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6426 (gdb) info macro Q
6427 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6428 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6429 #define Q <
6430 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6431 expands to: (42 + 1)
6432 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6433 expands to: once (M + 1)
6434 (gdb)
6435 @end smallexample
6436
6437 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6438 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6439 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6440 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6441
6442 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6443 the source line of the current stack frame:
6444
6445 @smallexample
6446 (gdb) break main
6447 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6448 (gdb) run
6449 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6450
6451 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6452 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6453 (gdb)
6454 @end smallexample
6455
6456 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6457
6458 @smallexample
6459 (gdb) info macro N
6460 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6461 #define N 28
6462 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6463 expands to: 28 < 42
6464 (gdb) print N Q M
6465 $1 = 1
6466 (gdb)
6467 @end smallexample
6468
6469 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6470 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6471 thereof) in force at each point:
6472
6473 @smallexample
6474 (gdb) next
6475 Hello, world!
6476 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6477 (gdb) info macro N
6478 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6479 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6480 (gdb) next
6481 We're so creative.
6482 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6483 (gdb) info macro N
6484 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6485 #define N 1729
6486 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6487 expands to: 1729 < 42
6488 (gdb) print N Q M
6489 $2 = 0
6490 (gdb)
6491 @end smallexample
6492
6493
6494 @node Tracepoints
6495 @chapter Tracepoints
6496 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6497 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6498
6499 @cindex tracepoints
6500 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6501 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6502 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6503 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6504 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6505 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6506 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6507
6508 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6509 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6510 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6511 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6512 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6513 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6514 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6515 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6516 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6517 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6518 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6519
6520 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6521 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6522 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6523 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6524 tracepoints as of this writing.
6525
6526 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6527
6528 @menu
6529 * Set Tracepoints::
6530 * Analyze Collected Data::
6531 * Tracepoint Variables::
6532 @end menu
6533
6534 @node Set Tracepoints
6535 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6536
6537 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6538 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6539 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6540 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6541 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6542 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6543 work on.
6544
6545 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6546 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6547 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6548 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6549 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6550 tracepoint was hit.
6551
6552 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6553 conditions and actions.
6554
6555 @menu
6556 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6557 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6558 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6559 * Tracepoint Actions::
6560 * Listing Tracepoints::
6561 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6562 @end menu
6563
6564 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6565 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6566
6567 @table @code
6568 @cindex set tracepoint
6569 @kindex trace
6570 @item trace
6571 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6572 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6573 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6574 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6575 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6576 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6577 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6578 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6579 running.
6580
6581 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6582
6583 @smallexample
6584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6585
6586 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6587
6588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6589
6590 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6591
6592 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6593 @end smallexample
6594
6595 @noindent
6596 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6597
6598 @vindex $tpnum
6599 @cindex last tracepoint number
6600 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6601 @cindex tracepoint number
6602 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6603 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6604
6605 @kindex delete tracepoint
6606 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6607 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6608 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6609 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6610
6611 Examples:
6612
6613 @smallexample
6614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6615
6616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6617 @end smallexample
6618
6619 @noindent
6620 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6621 @end table
6622
6623 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6624 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6625
6626 @table @code
6627 @kindex disable tracepoint
6628 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6629 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6630 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6631 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6632 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6633
6634 @kindex enable tracepoint
6635 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6636 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6637 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6638 run.
6639 @end table
6640
6641 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6642 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6643
6644 @table @code
6645 @kindex passcount
6646 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6647 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6648 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6649 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6650 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6651 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6652 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6653 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6654 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6655 user.
6656
6657 Examples:
6658
6659 @smallexample
6660 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6661 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6662
6663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6664 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6671 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6672 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6673 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6674 @end smallexample
6675 @end table
6676
6677 @node Tracepoint Actions
6678 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6679
6680 @table @code
6681 @kindex actions
6682 @cindex tracepoint actions
6683 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6684 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6685 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6686 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6687 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6688 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6689 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6690 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6691 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6692 @code{while-stepping}.
6693
6694 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6695 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6696 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6697
6698 @smallexample
6699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6700
6701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6702
6703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6704 @end smallexample
6705
6706 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6707 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6708 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6709 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6710 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6711 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6712 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6713 @code{end} command.
6714
6715 @smallexample
6716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6718 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6719 > collect bar,baz
6720 > collect $regs
6721 > while-stepping 12
6722 > collect $fp, $sp
6723 > end
6724 end
6725 @end smallexample
6726
6727 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6728 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6729 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6730 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6731 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6732 special arguments are supported:
6733
6734 @table @code
6735 @item $regs
6736 collect all registers
6737
6738 @item $args
6739 collect all function arguments
6740
6741 @item $locals
6742 collect all local variables.
6743 @end table
6744
6745 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6746 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6747 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6748
6749 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6750 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6751
6752 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6753 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6754 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6755 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6756 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6757 its own @code{end} command):
6758
6759 @smallexample
6760 > while-stepping 12
6761 > collect $regs, myglobal
6762 > end
6763 >
6764 @end smallexample
6765
6766 @noindent
6767 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6768 @code{stepping}.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 @node Listing Tracepoints
6772 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6773
6774 @table @code
6775 @kindex info tracepoints
6776 @cindex information about tracepoints
6777 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6778 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6779 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6780 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6781 shown:
6782
6783 @itemize @bullet
6784 @item
6785 its number
6786 @item
6787 whether it is enabled or disabled
6788 @item
6789 its address
6790 @item
6791 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6792 @item
6793 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6794 @item
6795 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6796 @item
6797 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6798 @end itemize
6799
6800 @smallexample
6801 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6802 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6803 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6804 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6805 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6806 (@value{GDBP})
6807 @end smallexample
6808
6809 @noindent
6810 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6811 @end table
6812
6813 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6814 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6815
6816 @table @code
6817 @kindex tstart
6818 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6819 @cindex collected data discarded
6820 @item tstart
6821 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6822 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6823 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6824 experiment.
6825
6826 @kindex tstop
6827 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6828 @item tstop
6829 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6830 stops collecting data.
6831
6832 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6833 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6834 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6835
6836 @kindex tstatus
6837 @cindex status of trace data collection
6838 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6839 @item tstatus
6840 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6841 collection.
6842 @end table
6843
6844 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6845
6846 @smallexample
6847 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6848 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6849 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6850 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6851 > while-stepping 11
6852 > collect $regs
6853 > end
6854 > end
6855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6856 [time passes @dots{}]
6857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6858 @end smallexample
6859
6860
6861 @node Analyze Collected Data
6862 @section Using the collected data
6863
6864 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6865 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6866 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6867 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6868 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6869 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6870 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6871 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6872 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6873 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6874 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6875 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6876 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6877 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6878 the buffer will fail.
6879
6880 @menu
6881 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6882 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6883 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6884 @end menu
6885
6886 @node tfind
6887 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6888
6889 @kindex tfind
6890 @cindex select trace snapshot
6891 @cindex find trace snapshot
6892 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6893 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6894 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6895 snapshot is selected.
6896
6897 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6898
6899 @table @code
6900 @item tfind start
6901 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6902 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6903
6904 @item tfind none
6905 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6906
6907 @item tfind end
6908 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6909
6910 @item tfind
6911 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6912
6913 @item tfind -
6914 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6915 retracing earlier steps.
6916
6917 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6918 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6919 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6920 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6921 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6922
6923 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6924 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6925 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6926 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6927 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6928
6929 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6930 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6931 addresses.
6932
6933 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6934 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6935 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6936
6937 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6938 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6939 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6940 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6941 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6942 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6943 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6944 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6945 @end table
6946
6947 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6948 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6949 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6950 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6951 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6952 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6953 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6954 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6955 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6956 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6957 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6958 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6959 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6960 tracepoint as the current one.
6961
6962 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6963 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6964 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6965 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6966 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6967
6968 @smallexample
6969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6971 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6972 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6973 > tfind
6974 > end
6975
6976 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6977 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6978 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6979 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6980 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6981 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6982 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6983 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6984 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6985 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6986 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6987 @end smallexample
6988
6989 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6990 the buffer:
6991
6992 @smallexample
6993 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6994 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6995 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6996 > tfind line
6997 > end
6998
6999 Frame 0, X = 1
7000 Frame 7, X = 2
7001 Frame 13, X = 255
7002 @end smallexample
7003
7004 @node tdump
7005 @subsection @code{tdump}
7006 @kindex tdump
7007 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7008 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7009
7010 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7011 the current trace snapshot.
7012
7013 @smallexample
7014 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7015 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7016 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7017 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7018 > end
7019
7020 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7021
7022 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7023 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7024 at gdb_test.c:444
7025 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7026
7027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7028 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7029 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7030 d1 0x18 24
7031 d2 0x80 128
7032 d3 0x33 51
7033 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7034 d5 0x22 34
7035 d6 0xe0 224
7036 d7 0x380035 3670069
7037 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7038 a1 0x3000668 50333288
7039 a2 0x100 256
7040 a3 0x322000 3284992
7041 a4 0x3000698 50333336
7042 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7043 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7044 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7045 ps 0x0 0
7046 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7047 fpcontrol 0x0 0
7048 fpstatus 0x0 0
7049 fpiaddr 0x0 0
7050 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7051 p1 = (void *) 0x11
7052 p2 = (void *) 0x22
7053 p3 = (void *) 0x33
7054 p4 = (void *) 0x44
7055 p5 = (void *) 0x55
7056 p6 = (void *) 0x66
7057 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7058
7059 (@value{GDBP})
7060 @end smallexample
7061
7062 @node save-tracepoints
7063 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7064 @kindex save-tracepoints
7065 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7066
7067 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7068 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7069 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7070 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7071 Files}).
7072
7073 @node Tracepoint Variables
7074 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7075 @cindex tracepoint variables
7076 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7077
7078 @table @code
7079 @vindex $trace_frame
7080 @item (int) $trace_frame
7081 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7082 snapshot is selected.
7083
7084 @vindex $tracepoint
7085 @item (int) $tracepoint
7086 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7087
7088 @vindex $trace_line
7089 @item (int) $trace_line
7090 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7091
7092 @vindex $trace_file
7093 @item (char []) $trace_file
7094 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7095
7096 @vindex $trace_func
7097 @item (char []) $trace_func
7098 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7099 @end table
7100
7101 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7102 use @code{output} instead.
7103
7104 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7105 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7106 data.
7107
7108 @smallexample
7109 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7110
7111 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7112 > output $trace_file
7113 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7114 > tfind
7115 > end
7116 @end smallexample
7117
7118 @node Overlays
7119 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7120 @cindex overlays
7121
7122 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7123 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7124 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7125 use overlays.
7126
7127 @menu
7128 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7129 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7130 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7131 mapped by asking the inferior.
7132 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7133 @end menu
7134
7135 @node How Overlays Work
7136 @section How Overlays Work
7137 @cindex mapped overlays
7138 @cindex unmapped overlays
7139 @cindex load address, overlay's
7140 @cindex mapped address
7141 @cindex overlay area
7142
7143 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7144 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7145 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7146 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7147 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7148
7149 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7150 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7151 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7152 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7153 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7154 largest overlay as well.
7155
7156 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7157 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7158 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7159 there.
7160
7161 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7162 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7163 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7164
7165 @smallexample
7166 @group
7167 Data Instruction Larger
7168 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7169 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7170 | | | | | |
7171 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7172 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7173 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7174 | and heap | | | | | |
7175 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7176 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7177 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7178 | | | | | |
7179 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7180 address | | | | | |
7181 | overlay | <-' | | |
7182 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7183 | | <---. | | load address
7184 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7185 | | | |
7186 +-----------+ | |
7187 +-----------+
7188 | |
7189 +-----------+
7190
7191 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7192 @end group
7193 @end smallexample
7194
7195 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7196 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7197 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7198 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7199 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7200 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7201 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7202 program and the overlay area.
7203
7204 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7205 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7206 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7207 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7208 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7209 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7210 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7211
7212 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7213 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7214 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7215
7216 @itemize @bullet
7217
7218 @item
7219 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7220 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7221 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7222 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7223
7224 @item
7225 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7226 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7227 your program's performance.
7228
7229 @item
7230 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7231 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7232 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7233 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7234 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7235 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7236 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7237
7238 @item
7239 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7240 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7241 instruction and data spaces.
7242
7243 @end itemize
7244
7245 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7246 improved in many ways:
7247
7248 @itemize @bullet
7249
7250 @item
7251 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7252 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7253 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7254 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7255 area in the usual way.
7256
7257 @item
7258 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7259 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7260
7261 @item
7262 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7263 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7264 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7265 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7266 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7267 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7268 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7269
7270 @end itemize
7271
7272
7273 @node Overlay Commands
7274 @section Overlay Commands
7275
7276 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7277 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7278 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7279 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7280 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7281 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7282
7283 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7284 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7285
7286 @table @code
7287 @item overlay off
7288 @kindex overlay off
7289 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7290 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7291 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7292 overlay support is disabled.
7293
7294 @item overlay manual
7295 @kindex overlay manual
7296 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7297 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7298 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7299 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7300 commands described below.
7301
7302 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7303 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7304 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7305 @cindex map an overlay
7306 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7307 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7308 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7309 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7310 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7311 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7312
7313 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7314 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7315 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7316 @cindex unmap an overlay
7317 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7318 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7319 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7320 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7321
7322 @item overlay auto
7323 @kindex overlay auto
7324 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7325 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7326 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7327 Overlay Debugging}.
7328
7329 @item overlay load-target
7330 @itemx overlay load
7331 @kindex overlay load-target
7332 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7333 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7334 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7335 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7336 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7337 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7338
7339 @item overlay list-overlays
7340 @itemx overlay list
7341 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7342 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7343 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7344
7345 @end table
7346
7347 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7348 of the function the address falls in:
7349
7350 @smallexample
7351 (gdb) print main
7352 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7353 @end smallexample
7354 @noindent
7355 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7356 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7357 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7358 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7359
7360 @smallexample
7361 (gdb) overlay list
7362 No sections are mapped.
7363 (gdb) print foo
7364 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7365 @end smallexample
7366 @noindent
7367 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7368 name normally:
7369
7370 @smallexample
7371 (gdb) overlay list
7372 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7373 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7374 (gdb) print foo
7375 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7376 @end smallexample
7377
7378 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7379 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7380 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7381 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7382 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7383
7384 @itemize @bullet
7385 @item
7386 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7387 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7388 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7389 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7390 @item
7391 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7392 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7393 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7394 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7395 breakpoints properly.
7396 @end itemize
7397
7398
7399 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7400 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7401 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7402
7403 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7404 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7405 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7406 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7407 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7408 current state of the overlays.
7409
7410 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7411 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7412
7413 @table @asis
7414
7415 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7416 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7417
7418 @smallexample
7419 struct
7420 @{
7421 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7422 unsigned long vma;
7423
7424 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7425 unsigned long size;
7426
7427 /* The overlay's load address. */
7428 unsigned long lma;
7429
7430 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7431 zero otherwise. */
7432 unsigned long mapped;
7433 @}
7434 @end smallexample
7435
7436 @item @code{_novlys}:
7437 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7438 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7439
7440 @end table
7441
7442 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7443 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7444 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7445 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7446 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7447 currently mapped.
7448
7449 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7450 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7451 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7452 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7453 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7454 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7455 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7456 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7457 are not being executed.
7458
7459 @node Overlay Sample Program
7460 @section Overlay Sample Program
7461 @cindex overlay example program
7462
7463 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7464 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7465 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7466 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7467 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7468 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7469 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7470
7471 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7472 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7473 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7474 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7475
7476 @table @file
7477 @item overlays.c
7478 The main program file.
7479 @item ovlymgr.c
7480 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7481 @item foo.c
7482 @itemx bar.c
7483 @itemx baz.c
7484 @itemx grbx.c
7485 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7486 @item d10v.ld
7487 @itemx m32r.ld
7488 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7489 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7490 @end table
7491
7492 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7493 cross-compiler like this:
7494
7495 @smallexample
7496 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7497 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7498 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7499 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7500 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7501 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7502 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7503 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7504 @end smallexample
7505
7506 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7507 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7508 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7509
7510
7511 @node Languages
7512 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7513 @cindex languages
7514
7515 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7516 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7517 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7518 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7519 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7520 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7521
7522 @cindex working language
7523 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7524 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7525 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7526 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7527 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7528 language}.
7529
7530 @menu
7531 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7532 * Show:: Displaying the language
7533 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7534 * Support:: Supported languages
7535 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
7536 @end menu
7537
7538 @node Setting
7539 @section Switching between source languages
7540
7541 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7542 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7543 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7544 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7545 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7546 are printed, etc.
7547
7548 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7549 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7550 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7551 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7552 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7553 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7554 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7555 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7556 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7557 Displaying the language}.
7558
7559 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7560 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7561 another language. In that case, make the
7562 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7563 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7564 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7565
7566 @menu
7567 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7568 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7569 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7570 @end menu
7571
7572 @node Filenames
7573 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7574
7575 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7576 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7577
7578 @table @file
7579
7580 @item .c
7581 C source file
7582
7583 @item .C
7584 @itemx .cc
7585 @itemx .cp
7586 @itemx .cpp
7587 @itemx .cxx
7588 @itemx .c++
7589 C@t{++} source file
7590
7591 @item .m
7592 Objective-C source file
7593
7594 @item .f
7595 @itemx .F
7596 Fortran source file
7597
7598 @item .mod
7599 Modula-2 source file
7600
7601 @item .s
7602 @itemx .S
7603 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7604 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7605 @end table
7606
7607 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7608 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7609
7610 @node Manually
7611 @subsection Setting the working language
7612
7613 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7614 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7615 your program.
7616
7617 @kindex set language
7618 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7619 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7620 a language, such as
7621 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7622 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7623
7624 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7625 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7626 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7627 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7628 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7629 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7630 command such as:
7631
7632 @smallexample
7633 print a = b + c
7634 @end smallexample
7635
7636 @noindent
7637 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7638 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7639 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7640 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7641
7642 @node Automatically
7643 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7644
7645 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7646 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7647 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7648 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7649 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7650 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7651 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7652 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7653 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7654
7655 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7656 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7657 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7658 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7659 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7660
7661 @node Show
7662 @section Displaying the language
7663
7664 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7665 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7666
7667 @kindex show language
7668 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7669 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7670 @table @code
7671 @item show language
7672 Display the current working language. This is the
7673 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7674 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7675
7676 @item info frame
7677 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7678 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7679 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7680 information listed here.
7681
7682 @item info source
7683 Display the source language of this source file.
7684 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7685 information listed here.
7686 @end table
7687
7688 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7689 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7690 with a language explicitly:
7691
7692 @kindex set extension-language
7693 @kindex info extensions
7694 @table @code
7695 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7696 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7697 the source language @var{language}.
7698
7699 @item info extensions
7700 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7701 @end table
7702
7703 @node Checks
7704 @section Type and range checking
7705
7706 @quotation
7707 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7708 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7709 section documents the intended facilities.
7710 @end quotation
7711 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7712
7713 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7714 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7715 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7716 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7717 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7718 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7719 errors when your program is running.
7720
7721 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7722 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7723 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7724 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7725 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7726 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7727 for the default settings of supported languages.
7728
7729 @menu
7730 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7731 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7732 @end menu
7733
7734 @cindex type checking
7735 @cindex checks, type
7736 @node Type Checking
7737 @subsection An overview of type checking
7738
7739 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7740 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7741 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7742 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7743
7744 @smallexample
7745 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7746 @exdent but
7747 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7748 @end smallexample
7749
7750 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7751 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7752
7753 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7754 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7755 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7756 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7757 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7758 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7759 also issues a warning.
7760
7761 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7762 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7763 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7764 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7765 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7766 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7767
7768 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7769 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7770 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7771 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7772 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7773 details on specific languages.
7774
7775 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7776
7777 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7778 @kindex set check type
7779 @kindex show check type
7780 @table @code
7781 @item set check type auto
7782 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7783 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7784 each language.
7785
7786 @item set check type on
7787 @itemx set check type off
7788 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7789 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7790 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7791 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7792 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7793
7794 @item set check type warn
7795 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7796 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7797 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7798 numbers and structures.
7799
7800 @item show type
7801 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7802 is setting it automatically.
7803 @end table
7804
7805 @cindex range checking
7806 @cindex checks, range
7807 @node Range Checking
7808 @subsection An overview of range checking
7809
7810 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7811 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7812 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7813 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7814 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7815
7816 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7817 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7818 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7819 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7820
7821 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7822 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7823 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7824 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7825 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7826 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7827
7828 @smallexample
7829 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7830 @end smallexample
7831
7832 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7833 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7834 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7835
7836 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7837
7838 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7839 @kindex set check range
7840 @kindex show check range
7841 @table @code
7842 @item set check range auto
7843 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7844 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7845 each language.
7846
7847 @item set check range on
7848 @itemx set check range off
7849 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7850 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7851 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7852 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7853
7854 @item set check range warn
7855 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7856 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7857 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7858 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7859 systems).
7860
7861 @item show range
7862 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7863 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7864 @end table
7865
7866 @node Support
7867 @section Supported languages
7868
7869 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
7870 @c This is false ...
7871 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7872 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7873 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7874 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7875 language.
7876
7877 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7878 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7879 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7880 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7881 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7882 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7883 language reference or tutorial.
7884
7885 @menu
7886 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7887 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
7888 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7889 @end menu
7890
7891 @node C
7892 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7893
7894 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7895 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7896
7897 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7898 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7899 together.
7900
7901 @cindex C@t{++}
7902 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7903 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7904 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7905 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7906 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7907 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7908 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7909
7910 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7911 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7912 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7913 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7914 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7915 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
7916
7917 @menu
7918 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7919 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7920 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7921 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7922 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7923 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7924 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7925 @end menu
7926
7927 @node C Operators
7928 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7929
7930 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7931
7932 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7933 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7934 often defined on groups of types.
7935
7936 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7937
7938 @itemize @bullet
7939
7940 @item
7941 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7942 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7943
7944 @item
7945 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7946 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7947
7948 @item
7949 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7950
7951 @item
7952 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7953
7954 @end itemize
7955
7956 @noindent
7957 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7958 in order of increasing precedence:
7959
7960 @table @code
7961 @item ,
7962 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7963 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7964 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7965
7966 @item =
7967 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7968 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7969
7970 @item @var{op}=
7971 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7972 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7973 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7974 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7975 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7976
7977 @item ?:
7978 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7979 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7980 integral type.
7981
7982 @item ||
7983 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7984
7985 @item &&
7986 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7987
7988 @item |
7989 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7990
7991 @item ^
7992 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7993
7994 @item &
7995 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7996
7997 @item ==@r{, }!=
7998 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7999 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8000
8001 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8002 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8003 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8004 and non-zero for true.
8005
8006 @item <<@r{, }>>
8007 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8008
8009 @item @@
8010 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8011
8012 @item +@r{, }-
8013 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8014 pointer types.
8015
8016 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8017 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8018 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8019 integral types.
8020
8021 @item ++@r{, }--
8022 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8023 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8024 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8025 operation takes place.
8026
8027 @item *
8028 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8029 @code{++}.
8030
8031 @item &
8032 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8033
8034 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8035 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
8036 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
8037 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
8038 stored.
8039
8040 @item -
8041 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8042 precedence as @code{++}.
8043
8044 @item !
8045 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8046 @code{++}.
8047
8048 @item ~
8049 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8050 @code{++}.
8051
8052
8053 @item .@r{, }->
8054 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8055 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8056 pointer based on the stored type information.
8057 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8058
8059 @item .*@r{, }->*
8060 Dereferences of pointers to members.
8061
8062 @item []
8063 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8064 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8065
8066 @item ()
8067 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8068
8069 @item ::
8070 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8071 and @code{class} types.
8072
8073 @item ::
8074 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8075 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8076 above.
8077 @end table
8078
8079 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8080 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8081 predefined meaning.
8082
8083 @menu
8084 * C Constants::
8085 @end menu
8086
8087 @node C Constants
8088 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8089
8090 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8091
8092 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8093 following ways:
8094
8095 @itemize @bullet
8096 @item
8097 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8098 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8099 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8100 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8101 @code{long} value.
8102
8103 @item
8104 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8105 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8106 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8107 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8108 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8109 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8110 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8111 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8112 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8113 constant.
8114
8115 @item
8116 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8117 integral equivalents.
8118
8119 @item
8120 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8121 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8122 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8123 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8124 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8125 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8126 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8127 @samp{\n} for newline.
8128
8129 @item
8130 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8131 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8132 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8133 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8134 characters.
8135
8136 @item
8137 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8138 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8139
8140 @item
8141 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8142 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8143 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8144 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8145 @end itemize
8146
8147 @menu
8148 * C plus plus expressions::
8149 * C Defaults::
8150 * C Checks::
8151
8152 * Debugging C::
8153 @end menu
8154
8155 @node C plus plus expressions
8156 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8157
8158 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8159 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8160
8161 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8162 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8163 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8164 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8165 @quotation
8166 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8167 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8168 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8169 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8170 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8171 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8172 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8173 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8174 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8175 C@t{++} code.
8176 @end quotation
8177
8178 @enumerate
8179
8180 @cindex member functions
8181 @item
8182 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8183
8184 @smallexample
8185 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8186 @end smallexample
8187
8188 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8189 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8190 @item
8191 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8192 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8193 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8194 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8195
8196 @cindex call overloaded functions
8197 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8198 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8199 @item
8200 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8201 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8202 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8203 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8204 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8205 default arguments.
8206
8207 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8208 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8209 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8210 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8211 number of function arguments.
8212
8213 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8214 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8215 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8216
8217 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8218 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8219 @smallexample
8220 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8221 @end smallexample
8222
8223 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8224 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8225
8226 @cindex reference declarations
8227 @item
8228 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8229 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8230 dereferenced.
8231
8232 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8233 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8234 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8235 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8236 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8237
8238 @item
8239 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8240 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8241 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8242 necessary, for example in an expression like
8243 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8244 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8245 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8246 @end enumerate
8247
8248 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8249 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8250 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8251 invoking user-defined operators.
8252
8253 @node C Defaults
8254 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8255
8256 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8257
8258 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8259 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8260 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8261 selects the working language.
8262
8263 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8264 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8265 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8266 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8267 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8268 for further details.
8269
8270 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8271 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8272 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8273
8274 @node C Checks
8275 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8276
8277 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8278
8279 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8280 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8281 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8282
8283 @itemize @bullet
8284 @item
8285 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8286 enumerated tag.
8287
8288 @item
8289 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8290 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8291
8292 @ignore
8293 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8294 @c FIXME--beers?
8295 @item
8296 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8297 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8298 compilers.)
8299 @end ignore
8300 @end itemize
8301
8302 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8303 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8304 that is not itself an array.
8305
8306 @node Debugging C
8307 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8308
8309 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8310 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8311 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8312 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8313
8314 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8315 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8316 ,Expressions}.
8317
8318 @menu
8319 * Debugging C plus plus::
8320 @end menu
8321
8322 @node Debugging C plus plus
8323 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8324
8325 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8326
8327 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8328 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8329
8330 @table @code
8331 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8332 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8333 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8334 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8335 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8336
8337 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8338 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8339 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8340 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8341 classes.
8342 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8343
8344 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8345 @item catch throw
8346 @itemx catch catch
8347 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8348 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8349
8350 @cindex inheritance
8351 @item ptype @var{typename}
8352 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8353 @var{typename}.
8354 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8355
8356 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8357 @item set print demangle
8358 @itemx show print demangle
8359 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8360 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8361 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8362 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8363 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8364
8365 @item set print object
8366 @itemx show print object
8367 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8368 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8369
8370 @item set print vtbl
8371 @itemx show print vtbl
8372 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8373 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8374 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8375 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8376
8377 @kindex set overload-resolution
8378 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8379 @item set overload-resolution on
8380 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8381 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8382 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8383 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8384 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8385 message.
8386
8387 @item set overload-resolution off
8388 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8389 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8390 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8391 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8392 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8393 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8394 argument types.
8395
8396 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8397 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8398 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8399 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8400 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8401 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8402 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8403 @end table
8404
8405 @node Objective-C
8406 @subsection Objective-C
8407
8408 @cindex Objective-C
8409 This section provides information about some commands and command
8410 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.
8411
8412 @menu
8413 * Method Names in Commands::
8414 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
8415 @end menu
8416
8417 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
8418 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
8419
8420 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
8421 names as line specifications:
8422
8423 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
8424 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
8425 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
8426 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
8427 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
8428 @itemize
8429 @item @code{clear}
8430 @item @code{break}
8431 @item @code{info line}
8432 @item @code{jump}
8433 @item @code{list}
8434 @end itemize
8435
8436 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
8437
8438 @smallexample
8439 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
8440 @end smallexample
8441
8442 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a plus
8443 sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The
8444 class name @var{Class} and method name @var{methoName} are enclosed in
8445 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C source
8446 code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create} instance method of
8447 class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being debugged, enter:
8448
8449 @smallexample
8450 break -[Fruit create]
8451 @end smallexample
8452
8453 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
8454 enter:
8455
8456 @smallexample
8457 list +[NSText initialize]
8458 @end smallexample
8459
8460 In the current version of GDB, the plus or minus sign is required. In
8461 future versions of GDB, the plus or minus sign will be optional, but you
8462 can use it to narrow the search. It is also possible to specify just a
8463 method name:
8464
8465 @smallexample
8466 break create
8467 @end smallexample
8468
8469 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
8470 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
8471 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
8472 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
8473 none apply.
8474
8475 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
8476 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
8477
8478 @smallexample
8479 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
8480 @end smallexample
8481
8482 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
8483 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
8484
8485 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
8486
8487 @smallexample
8488 print -[object hash]
8489 @end smallexample
8490
8491 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
8492 will tell gdb to send the -hash message to object and print the
8493 result. Also an additional command has been added, @code{print-object}
8494 or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print the description of an
8495 object. However, this command may only work with certain Objective-C
8496 libraries that have a particular hook function, called
8497 @code{_NSPrintForDebugger} defined.
8498
8499 @node Modula-2, , Objective-C, Support
8500 @subsection Modula-2
8501
8502 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8503
8504 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8505 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8506 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8507 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8508 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8509 table.
8510
8511 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8512 @menu
8513 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8514 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8515 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8516 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8517 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8518 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8519 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8520 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8521 @end menu
8522
8523 @node M2 Operators
8524 @subsubsection Operators
8525 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8526
8527 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8528 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8529 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8530 following definitions hold:
8531
8532 @itemize @bullet
8533
8534 @item
8535 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8536 their subranges.
8537
8538 @item
8539 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8540
8541 @item
8542 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8543
8544 @item
8545 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8546 @var{type}}.
8547
8548 @item
8549 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8550
8551 @item
8552 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8553
8554 @item
8555 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8556 @end itemize
8557
8558 @noindent
8559 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8560 increasing precedence:
8561
8562 @table @code
8563 @item ,
8564 Function argument or array index separator.
8565
8566 @item :=
8567 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8568 @var{value}.
8569
8570 @item <@r{, }>
8571 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8572 types.
8573
8574 @item <=@r{, }>=
8575 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8576 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8577 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8578
8579 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8580 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8581 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8582 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8583 comment character.
8584
8585 @item IN
8586 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8587 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8588
8589 @item OR
8590 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8591
8592 @item AND@r{, }&
8593 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8594
8595 @item @@
8596 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8597
8598 @item +@r{, }-
8599 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8600 and difference on set types.
8601
8602 @item *
8603 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8604 on set types.
8605
8606 @item /
8607 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8608 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8609
8610 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8611 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8612 precedence as @code{*}.
8613
8614 @item -
8615 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8616
8617 @item ^
8618 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8619
8620 @item NOT
8621 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8622 @code{^}.
8623
8624 @item .
8625 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8626 precedence as @code{^}.
8627
8628 @item []
8629 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8630
8631 @item ()
8632 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8633 as @code{^}.
8634
8635 @item ::@r{, }.
8636 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8637 @end table
8638
8639 @quotation
8640 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8641 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8642 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8643 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8644 @end quotation
8645
8646
8647 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8648 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8649 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8650
8651 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8652 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8653
8654 @table @var
8655
8656 @item a
8657 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8658
8659 @item c
8660 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8661
8662 @item i
8663 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8664
8665 @item m
8666 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8667 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8668 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8669
8670 @item n
8671 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8672
8673 @item r
8674 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8675
8676 @item t
8677 represents a type.
8678
8679 @item v
8680 represents a variable.
8681
8682 @item x
8683 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8684 explanation of the function for details.
8685 @end table
8686
8687 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8688
8689 @table @code
8690 @item ABS(@var{n})
8691 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8692
8693 @item CAP(@var{c})
8694 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8695 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8696
8697 @item CHR(@var{i})
8698 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8699
8700 @item DEC(@var{v})
8701 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8702
8703 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8704 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8705 new value.
8706
8707 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8708 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8709 set.
8710
8711 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8712 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8713
8714 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8715 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8716
8717 @item INC(@var{v})
8718 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8719
8720 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8721 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8722 new value.
8723
8724 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8725 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8726 there. Returns the new set.
8727
8728 @item MAX(@var{t})
8729 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8730
8731 @item MIN(@var{t})
8732 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8733
8734 @item ODD(@var{i})
8735 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8736
8737 @item ORD(@var{x})
8738 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8739 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8740 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8741 integral, character and enumerated types.
8742
8743 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8744 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8745
8746 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8747 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8748
8749 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8750 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8751 @end table
8752
8753 @quotation
8754 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8755 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8756 an error.
8757 @end quotation
8758
8759 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8760 @node M2 Constants
8761 @subsubsection Constants
8762
8763 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8764 ways:
8765
8766 @itemize @bullet
8767
8768 @item
8769 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8770 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8771 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8772 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8773
8774 @item
8775 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8776 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8777 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8778 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8779 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8780 digits.
8781
8782 @item
8783 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8784 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8785 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8786 followed by a @samp{C}.
8787
8788 @item
8789 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8790 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8791 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8792 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8793 sequences.
8794
8795 @item
8796 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8797
8798 @item
8799 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8800 @code{FALSE}.
8801
8802 @item
8803 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8804
8805 @item
8806 Set constants are not yet supported.
8807 @end itemize
8808
8809 @node M2 Defaults
8810 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8811 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8812
8813 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8814 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8815 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8816 selected the working language.
8817
8818 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8819 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8820 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8821 the language automatically}, for further details.
8822
8823 @node Deviations
8824 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8825 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8826
8827 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8828 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8829
8830 @itemize @bullet
8831 @item
8832 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8833 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8834 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8835 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8836 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8837 returned a pointer.)
8838
8839 @item
8840 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8841 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8842 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8843 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8844
8845 @item
8846 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8847 argument.
8848
8849 @item
8850 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8851 @end itemize
8852
8853 @node M2 Checks
8854 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8855 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8856
8857 @quotation
8858 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8859 range checking.
8860 @end quotation
8861 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8862
8863 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8864
8865 @itemize @bullet
8866 @item
8867 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8868 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8869
8870 @item
8871 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8872 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8873 @end itemize
8874
8875 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8876 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8877
8878 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8879 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8880
8881 @node M2 Scope
8882 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8883 @cindex scope
8884 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8885 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8886 @ifinfo
8887 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8888 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8889 @end ifinfo
8890 @iftex
8891 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8892 @end iftex
8893
8894 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8895 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8896 similar syntax:
8897
8898 @smallexample
8899
8900 @var{module} . @var{id}
8901 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8902 @end smallexample
8903
8904 @noindent
8905 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8906 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8907 identifier within your program, except another module.
8908
8909 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8910 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8911 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8912 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8913
8914 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8915 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8916 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8917 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8918 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8919 @var{module}.
8920
8921 @node GDB/M2
8922 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8923
8924 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8925 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8926 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8927 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8928 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8929 analogue in Modula-2.
8930
8931 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8932 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8933 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8934 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8935 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8936 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8937
8938 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8939 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8940 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8941
8942 @node Unsupported languages
8943 @section Unsupported languages
8944
8945 @cindex unsupported languages
8946 @cindex minimal language
8947 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
8948 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
8949 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
8950 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
8951 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
8952 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
8953
8954 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
8955 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
8956 language.
8957
8958 @node Symbols
8959 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8960
8961 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8962 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8963 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8964 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8965 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8966 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8967 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8968
8969 @cindex symbol names
8970 @cindex names of symbols
8971 @cindex quoting names
8972 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8973 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8974 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8975 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8976 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8977 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8978 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8979 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8980
8981 @smallexample
8982 p 'foo.c'::x
8983 @end smallexample
8984
8985 @noindent
8986 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8987
8988 @table @code
8989 @kindex info address
8990 @cindex address of a symbol
8991 @item info address @var{symbol}
8992 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8993 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8994 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8995 is always stored.
8996
8997 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8998 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8999 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
9000
9001 @kindex info symbol
9002 @cindex symbol from address
9003 @item info symbol @var{addr}
9004 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
9005 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
9006 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
9007
9008 @smallexample
9009 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
9010 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
9011 @end smallexample
9012
9013 @noindent
9014 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
9015 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
9016
9017 @kindex whatis
9018 @item whatis @var{expr}
9019 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
9020 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
9021 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
9022 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9023
9024 @item whatis
9025 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9026
9027 @kindex ptype
9028 @item ptype @var{typename}
9029 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
9030 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
9031 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
9032 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
9033
9034 @item ptype @var{expr}
9035 @itemx ptype
9036 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
9037 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
9038 of just the name of the type.
9039
9040 For example, for this variable declaration:
9041
9042 @smallexample
9043 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
9044 @end smallexample
9045
9046 @noindent
9047 the two commands give this output:
9048
9049 @smallexample
9050 @group
9051 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
9052 type = struct complex
9053 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
9054 type = struct complex @{
9055 double real;
9056 double imag;
9057 @}
9058 @end group
9059 @end smallexample
9060
9061 @noindent
9062 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
9063 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9064
9065 @kindex info types
9066 @item info types @var{regexp}
9067 @itemx info types
9068 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
9069 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9070 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9071 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
9072 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
9073 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9074
9075 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9076 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9077 lists all source files where a type is defined.
9078
9079 @kindex info scope
9080 @cindex local variables
9081 @item info scope @var{addr}
9082 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9083 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9084 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9085 scope defined by that location. For example:
9086
9087 @smallexample
9088 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9089 Scope for command_line_handler:
9090 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9091 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9092 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9093 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9094 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9095 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9096 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9097 @end smallexample
9098
9099 @noindent
9100 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9101 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9102 collect}.
9103
9104 @kindex info source
9105 @item info source
9106 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9107 the function containing the current point of execution:
9108 @itemize @bullet
9109 @item
9110 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9111 @item
9112 the directory it was compiled in,
9113 @item
9114 its length, in lines,
9115 @item
9116 which programming language it is written in,
9117 @item
9118 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9119 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9120 @item
9121 whether the debugging information includes information about
9122 preprocessor macros.
9123 @end itemize
9124
9125
9126 @kindex info sources
9127 @item info sources
9128 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9129 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9130 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9131
9132 @kindex info functions
9133 @item info functions
9134 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9135
9136 @item info functions @var{regexp}
9137 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9138 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9139 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9140 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
9141 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9142 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9143 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
9144
9145 @kindex info variables
9146 @item info variables
9147 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
9148 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
9149
9150 @item info variables @var{regexp}
9151 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9152 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9153 @var{regexp}.
9154
9155 @kindex info classes
9156 @item info classes
9157 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
9158 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
9159 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9160 expression.
9161
9162 @kindex info selectors
9163 @item info selectors
9164 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
9165 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
9166 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9167 expression.
9168
9169 @ignore
9170 This was never implemented.
9171 @kindex info methods
9172 @item info methods
9173 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9174 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
9175 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9176 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9177 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
9178 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9179 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9180 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9181 @end ignore
9182
9183 @cindex reloading symbols
9184 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
9185 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9186 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9187 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9188 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
9189
9190 @table @code
9191 @kindex set symbol-reloading
9192 @item set symbol-reloading on
9193 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9194 object file with a particular name is seen again.
9195
9196 @item set symbol-reloading off
9197 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9198 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9199 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9200 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9201 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9202 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9203 name.
9204
9205 @kindex show symbol-reloading
9206 @item show symbol-reloading
9207 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9208 @end table
9209
9210 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9211 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
9212 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9213 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9214 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9215 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9216 another source file. The default is on.
9217
9218 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9219 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9220
9221 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
9222 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9223 is printed as follows:
9224 @smallexample
9225 @{<no data fields>@}
9226 @end smallexample
9227
9228 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9229 @item show opaque-type-resolution
9230 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
9231
9232 @kindex maint print symbols
9233 @cindex symbol dump
9234 @kindex maint print psymbols
9235 @cindex partial symbol dump
9236 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9237 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9238 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9239 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9240 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9241 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9242 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9243 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9244 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9245 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9246 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9247 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9248 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9249 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9250 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9251 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9252 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9253
9254 @kindex maint info symtabs
9255 @kindex maint info psymtabs
9256 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
9257 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9258 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9259 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9260 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9261 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9262
9263 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
9264 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
9265 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
9266 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
9267 structure in more detail. For example:
9268
9269 @smallexample
9270 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
9271 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9272 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9273 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9274 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
9275 readin no
9276 fullname (null)
9277 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
9278 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
9279 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
9280 dependencies (none)
9281 @}
9282 @}
9283 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9284 (@value{GDBP})
9285 @end smallexample
9286 @noindent
9287 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
9288 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
9289 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
9290 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
9291 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
9292
9293 @smallexample
9294 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
9295 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
9296 line 1574.
9297 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9298 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9299 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9300 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9301 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
9302 dirname (null)
9303 fullname (null)
9304 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
9305 debugformat DWARF 2
9306 @}
9307 @}
9308 (@value{GDBP})
9309 @end smallexample
9310 @end table
9311
9312
9313 @node Altering
9314 @chapter Altering Execution
9315
9316 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9317 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9318 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9319 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9320 program.
9321
9322 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9323 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9324 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9325
9326 @menu
9327 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9328 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9329 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9330 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9331 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9332 * Patching:: Patching your program
9333 @end menu
9334
9335 @node Assignment
9336 @section Assignment to variables
9337
9338 @cindex assignment
9339 @cindex setting variables
9340 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9341 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9342
9343 @smallexample
9344 print x=4
9345 @end smallexample
9346
9347 @noindent
9348 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9349 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9350 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9351 information on operators in supported languages.
9352
9353 @kindex set variable
9354 @cindex variables, setting
9355 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9356 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9357 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9358 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9359 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9360
9361 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9362 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9363 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9364 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9365 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9366 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9367 command @code{set width}:
9368
9369 @smallexample
9370 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9371 type = double
9372 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9373 $4 = 13
9374 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9375 Invalid syntax in expression.
9376 @end smallexample
9377
9378 @noindent
9379 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9380 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9381
9382 @smallexample
9383 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9384 @end smallexample
9385
9386 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9387 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9388 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9389 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9390 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9391 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9392
9393 @smallexample
9394 @group
9395 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9396 type = double
9397 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9398 $1 = 1
9399 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9400 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9401 $2 = 1
9402 (@value{GDBP}) r
9403 The program being debugged has been started already.
9404 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9405 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9406 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9407 Invalid bfd target.
9408 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9409 The current BFD target is "=4".
9410 @end group
9411 @end smallexample
9412
9413 @noindent
9414 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9415 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9416 @code{g}, use
9417
9418 @smallexample
9419 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9420 @end smallexample
9421
9422 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9423 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9424 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9425 same length or shorter.
9426 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9427 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9428
9429 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9430 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9431 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9432 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9433 and representation in memory), and
9434
9435 @smallexample
9436 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9437 @end smallexample
9438
9439 @noindent
9440 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9441
9442 @node Jumping
9443 @section Continuing at a different address
9444
9445 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9446 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9447 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9448
9449 @table @code
9450 @kindex jump
9451 @item jump @var{linespec}
9452 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9453 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9454 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9455 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9456 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9457 breakpoints}.
9458
9459 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9460 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9461 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9462 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9463 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9464 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9465 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9466 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9467 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9468
9469 @item jump *@var{address}
9470 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9471 @end table
9472
9473 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9474 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9475 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9476 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9477 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9478 example,
9479
9480 @smallexample
9481 set $pc = 0x485
9482 @end smallexample
9483
9484 @noindent
9485 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9486 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9487 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9488
9489 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9490 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9491 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9492 detail.
9493
9494 @c @group
9495 @node Signaling
9496 @section Giving your program a signal
9497
9498 @table @code
9499 @kindex signal
9500 @item signal @var{signal}
9501 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9502 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9503 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9504 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9505
9506 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9507 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9508 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9509 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9510 signal.
9511
9512 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9513 after executing the command.
9514 @end table
9515 @c @end group
9516
9517 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9518 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9519 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9520 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9521 passes the signal directly to your program.
9522
9523
9524 @node Returning
9525 @section Returning from a function
9526
9527 @table @code
9528 @cindex returning from a function
9529 @kindex return
9530 @item return
9531 @itemx return @var{expression}
9532 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9533 command. If you give an
9534 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9535 value.
9536 @end table
9537
9538 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9539 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9540 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9541 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9542
9543 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9544 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9545 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9546 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9547 of functions.
9548
9549 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9550 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9551 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9552 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9553 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9554
9555 @node Calling
9556 @section Calling program functions
9557
9558 @cindex calling functions
9559 @kindex call
9560 @table @code
9561 @item call @var{expr}
9562 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9563 returned values.
9564 @end table
9565
9566 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9567 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9568 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9569 is printed and saved in the value history.
9570
9571 @node Patching
9572 @section Patching programs
9573
9574 @cindex patching binaries
9575 @cindex writing into executables
9576 @cindex writing into corefiles
9577
9578 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9579 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9580 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9581 patching your program's binary.
9582
9583 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9584 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9585 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9586 repairs.
9587
9588 @table @code
9589 @kindex set write
9590 @item set write on
9591 @itemx set write off
9592 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9593 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9594 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9595
9596 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9597 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9598 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9599
9600 @item show write
9601 @kindex show write
9602 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9603 as well as reading.
9604 @end table
9605
9606 @node GDB Files
9607 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9608
9609 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9610 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9611 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9612 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9613
9614 @menu
9615 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9616 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
9617 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9618 @end menu
9619
9620 @node Files
9621 @section Commands to specify files
9622
9623 @cindex symbol table
9624 @cindex core dump file
9625
9626 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9627 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9628 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9629 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9630
9631 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9632 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9633 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9634 to specify new files are useful.
9635
9636 @table @code
9637 @cindex executable file
9638 @kindex file
9639 @item file @var{filename}
9640 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9641 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9642 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9643 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9644 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9645 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9646 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9647 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9648
9649 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9650 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9651 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9652 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9653 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9654 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9655 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9656 for more information.
9657
9658 @item file
9659 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9660 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9661
9662 @kindex exec-file
9663 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9664 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9665 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9666 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9667 discard information on the executable file.
9668
9669 @kindex symbol-file
9670 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9671 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9672 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9673 table and program to run from the same file.
9674
9675 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9676 program's symbol table.
9677
9678 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9679 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9680 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9681 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9682 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9683
9684 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9685 executing it once.
9686
9687 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9688 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9689 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9690 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9691 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9692 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9693 optimized code.
9694
9695 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9696 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9697 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9698 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9699 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9700
9701 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9702 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9703 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9704 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9705 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9706 warnings and messages}.)
9707
9708 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9709 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9710 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9711 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9712 in stabs format.
9713
9714 @kindex readnow
9715 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9716 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9717 @kindex mapped
9718 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9719 @cindex saving symbol table
9720 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9721 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9722 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9723 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9724 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9725 entire symbol table available.
9726
9727 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9728 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9729 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9730 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9731 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9732 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9733 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9734 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9735
9736 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9737 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9738
9739 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9740 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9741 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9742 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9743 needed.
9744
9745 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9746 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9747 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9748
9749 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9750 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9751 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9752 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9753 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9754 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9755 @c files.
9756
9757 @kindex core
9758 @kindex core-file
9759 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9760 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9761 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9762 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9763 executable file itself for other parts.
9764
9765 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9766 to be used.
9767
9768 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9769 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9770 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9771 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9772 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9773
9774 @kindex add-symbol-file
9775 @cindex dynamic linking
9776 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9777 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9778 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9779 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9780 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9781 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9782 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9783 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9784 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9785 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9786 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9787 @var{address} as an expression.
9788
9789 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9790 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9791 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9792 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9793 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9794
9795 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9796 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9797 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9798 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9799 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9800 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9801 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9802 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9803 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9804
9805 @itemize @bullet
9806 @item
9807 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9808 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9809 @item
9810 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9811 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9812 @item
9813 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9814 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9815 @end itemize
9816
9817 @noindent
9818 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9819 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9820 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9821 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9822 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9823 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9824 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9825 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9826 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9827 way.
9828
9829 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9830
9831 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9832 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9833 table information for @var{filename}.
9834
9835 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9836 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9837 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9838 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9839 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9840 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9841
9842 @kindex section
9843 @item section
9844 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9845 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9846 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9847 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9848 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9849 the sections and their addresses.
9850
9851 @kindex info files
9852 @kindex info target
9853 @item info files
9854 @itemx info target
9855 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9856 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9857 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9858 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9859 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9860 current ones.
9861
9862 @kindex maint info sections
9863 @item maint info sections
9864 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9865 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9866 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9867 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9868 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9869 may be arbitrarily combined):
9870
9871 @table @code
9872 @item ALLOBJ
9873 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9874 @item @var{sections}
9875 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9876 @item @var{section-flags}
9877 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9878 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9879 @table @code
9880 @item ALLOC
9881 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9882 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9883 @item LOAD
9884 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9885 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9886 @item RELOC
9887 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9888 @item READONLY
9889 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9890 @item CODE
9891 Section contains executable code only.
9892 @item DATA
9893 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9894 @item ROM
9895 Section will reside in ROM.
9896 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9897 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9898 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9899 Section is not empty.
9900 @item NEVER_LOAD
9901 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9902 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9903 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9904 COFF shared library information.
9905 @item IS_COMMON
9906 Section contains common symbols.
9907 @end table
9908 @end table
9909 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9910 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9911 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9912 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9913 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9914 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9915 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9916 enhancement to debugging performance.
9917
9918 The default is off.
9919
9920 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9921 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9922 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9923 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9924 @end table
9925
9926 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9927 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9928 name and remembers it that way.
9929
9930 @cindex shared libraries
9931 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9932 libraries.
9933
9934 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9935 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9936 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9937 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9938 debugging a core file).
9939
9940 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9941 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9942
9943 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9944 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9945 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9946
9947 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9948 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9949 particularly large or there are many of them.
9950
9951 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9952 commands:
9953
9954 @table @code
9955 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9956 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9957 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9958 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9959 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9960 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9961 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9962 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9963
9964 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9965 @item show auto-solib-add
9966 Display the current autoloading mode.
9967 @end table
9968
9969 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9970 command:
9971
9972 @table @code
9973 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9974 @kindex info share
9975 @item info share
9976 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9977 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9978
9979 @kindex sharedlibrary
9980 @kindex share
9981 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9982 @itemx share @var{regex}
9983 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9984 Unix regular expression.
9985 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9986 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9987 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9988 loaded.
9989 @end table
9990
9991 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9992 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9993 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9994 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9995 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9996 wish.
9997
9998 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9999 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
10000 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
10001 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
10002
10003 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
10004
10005 @table @code
10006 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
10007 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
10008 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
10009 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
10010 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
10011 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
10012 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10013 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
10014 Mb).
10015
10016 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
10017 @item show auto-solib-limit
10018 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
10019 @end table
10020
10021 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
10022 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
10023 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
10024 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
10025 not.
10026
10027 You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
10028 load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
10029 @value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
10030 libraries.
10031
10032 @table @code
10033 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
10034 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
10035 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
10036 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
10037 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
10038 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
10039 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
10040 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
10041
10042 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
10043 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
10044
10045 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
10046 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
10047 Display the current shared library prefix.
10048
10049 @kindex set solib-search-path
10050 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
10051 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
10052 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
10053 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
10054 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
10055 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
10056 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
10057 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
10058
10059 @kindex show solib-search-path
10060 @item show solib-search-path
10061 Display the current shared library search path.
10062 @end table
10063
10064
10065 @node Separate Debug Files
10066 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
10067 @cindex separate debugging information files
10068 @cindex debugging information in separate files
10069 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
10070 @cindex debugging information directory, global
10071 @cindex global debugging information directory
10072
10073 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
10074 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
10075 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
10076 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
10077 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
10078 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
10079 install only when they need to debug a problem.
10080
10081 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
10082 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
10083 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
10084 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
10085 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
10086 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
10087 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
10088 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
10089 places:
10090
10091 @itemize @bullet
10092 @item
10093 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
10094 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
10095 @item
10096 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
10097 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
10098 @item
10099 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
10100 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
10101 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
10102 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
10103 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
10104 @end itemize
10105 @noindent
10106 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
10107 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
10108 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
10109
10110 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
10111 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
10112 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
10113 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
10114 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
10115 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
10116
10117 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
10118 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
10119
10120 @table @code
10121
10122 @kindex set debug-file-directory
10123 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
10124 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10125 information files to @var{directory}.
10126
10127 @kindex show debug-file-directory
10128 @item show debug-file-directory
10129 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10130 information files.
10131
10132 @end table
10133
10134 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
10135 @cindex debug links
10136 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
10137 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
10138
10139 @itemize
10140 @item
10141 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
10142 a zero byte,
10143 @item
10144 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
10145 boundary within the section, and
10146 @item
10147 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
10148 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
10149 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
10150 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
10151 @end itemize
10152
10153 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
10154 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
10155 described above.
10156
10157 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
10158 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
10159 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
10160 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
10161 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
10162 in an ordinary executable.
10163
10164 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
10165 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
10166 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
10167 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
10168 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
10169 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
10170 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
10171
10172 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
10173 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
10174 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
10175 complete code for a function that computes it:
10176
10177 @kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
10178 @smallexample
10179 unsigned long
10180 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
10181 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
10182 @{
10183 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
10184 @{
10185 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
10186 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
10187 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
10188 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
10189 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
10190 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
10191 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
10192 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
10193 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
10194 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
10195 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
10196 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
10197 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
10198 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
10199 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
10200 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
10201 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
10202 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
10203 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
10204 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
10205 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
10206 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
10207 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
10208 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
10209 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
10210 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
10211 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
10212 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
10213 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
10214 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
10215 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
10216 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
10217 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
10218 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
10219 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
10220 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
10221 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
10222 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
10223 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
10224 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
10225 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
10226 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
10227 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
10228 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
10229 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
10230 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
10231 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
10232 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
10233 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
10234 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
10235 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
10236 0x2d02ef8d
10237 @};
10238 unsigned char *end;
10239
10240 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10241 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
10242 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
10243 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10244 @}
10245 @end smallexample
10246
10247
10248 @node Symbol Errors
10249 @section Errors reading symbol files
10250
10251 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10252 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10253 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10254 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10255 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10256 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10257 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10258 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10259 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10260 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10261 messages}).
10262
10263 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10264
10265 @table @code
10266 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10267
10268 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10269 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10270 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10271 in its outer scope blocks.
10272
10273 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10274 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10275 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10276 function.
10277
10278 @item block at @var{address} out of order
10279
10280 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10281 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10282 do so.
10283
10284 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10285 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10286 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10287 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10288 messages}.)
10289
10290 @item bad block start address patched
10291
10292 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10293 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10294 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10295
10296 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10297 starting on the previous source line.
10298
10299 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10300
10301 @cindex foo
10302 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10303 larger than the size of the string table.
10304
10305 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10306 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10307 with this name.
10308
10309 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10310
10311 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10312 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
10313 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
10314
10315 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10316 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
10317 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
10318 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10319 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10320 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
10321
10322 @item stub type has NULL name
10323
10324 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
10325
10326 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
10327 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
10328 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10329 it.
10330
10331 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10332
10333 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
10334
10335 @end table
10336
10337 @node Targets
10338 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
10339
10340 @cindex debugging target
10341 @kindex target
10342
10343 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
10344
10345 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10346 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10347 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
10348 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10349 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
10350 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10351 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10352 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10353
10354 @menu
10355 * Active Targets:: Active targets
10356 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
10357 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10358 * Remote:: Remote debugging
10359 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
10360
10361 @end menu
10362
10363 @node Active Targets
10364 @section Active targets
10365
10366 @cindex stacking targets
10367 @cindex active targets
10368 @cindex multiple targets
10369
10370 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
10371 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10372 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10373 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10374 a core file.
10375
10376 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10377 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10378 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10379 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10380 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10381 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10382 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10383 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10384 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
10385
10386 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
10387 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10388 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10389 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10390 process target is active.
10391
10392 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10393 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
10394 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
10395 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10396 process}).
10397
10398 @node Target Commands
10399 @section Commands for managing targets
10400
10401 @table @code
10402 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
10403 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10404 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10405 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10406 protocol of the target machine.
10407
10408 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10409 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10410 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
10411
10412 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10413 after executing the command.
10414
10415 @kindex help target
10416 @item help target
10417 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10418 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10419 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10420
10421 @item help target @var{name}
10422 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10423 select it.
10424
10425 @kindex set gnutarget
10426 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
10427 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
10428 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
10429 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10430 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
10431 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10432
10433 @quotation
10434 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10435 you must know the actual BFD name.
10436 @end quotation
10437
10438 @noindent
10439 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
10440
10441 @kindex show gnutarget
10442 @item show gnutarget
10443 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10444 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10445 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10446 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10447 @end table
10448
10449 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10450 configuration):
10451
10452 @table @code
10453 @kindex target exec
10454 @item target exec @var{program}
10455 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10456 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10457
10458 @kindex target core
10459 @item target core @var{filename}
10460 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10461 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
10462
10463 @kindex target remote
10464 @item target remote @var{dev}
10465 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10466 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10467 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
10468 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
10469 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10470 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10471
10472 @kindex target sim
10473 @item target sim
10474 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
10475 In general,
10476 @smallexample
10477 target sim
10478 load
10479 run
10480 @end smallexample
10481 @noindent
10482 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
10483 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
10484 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10485 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10486 Processors}.
10487
10488 @end table
10489
10490 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
10491
10492 @table @code
10493
10494 @kindex target nrom
10495 @item target nrom @var{dev}
10496 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10497
10498 @end table
10499
10500 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
10501 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
10502
10503 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10504 once you've successfully established a connection.
10505
10506 @table @code
10507
10508 @kindex load @var{filename}
10509 @item load @var{filename}
10510 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10511 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10512 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10513 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10514 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10515 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10516
10517 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10518 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10519 target is @dots{}}''
10520
10521 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10522 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10523 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10524 specifies a fixed address.
10525 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10526
10527 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10528 @end table
10529
10530 @node Byte Order
10531 @section Choosing target byte order
10532
10533 @cindex choosing target byte order
10534 @cindex target byte order
10535
10536 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
10537 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10538 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10539 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10540 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10541 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10542
10543 @table @code
10544 @kindex set endian big
10545 @item set endian big
10546 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10547
10548 @kindex set endian little
10549 @item set endian little
10550 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10551
10552 @kindex set endian auto
10553 @item set endian auto
10554 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10555 executable.
10556
10557 @item show endian
10558 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10559
10560 @end table
10561
10562 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10563 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10564 target system.
10565
10566 @node Remote
10567 @section Remote debugging
10568 @cindex remote debugging
10569
10570 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10571 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10572 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10573 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10574 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10575
10576 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10577 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10578 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10579 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10580 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10581 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10582
10583 Other remote targets may be available in your
10584 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10585
10586 @node KOD
10587 @section Kernel Object Display
10588
10589 @cindex kernel object display
10590 @cindex kernel object
10591 @cindex KOD
10592
10593 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10594 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10595 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10596 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10597 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10598
10599 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10600 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10601
10602 @smallexample
10603 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10604 @end smallexample
10605
10606 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10607 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10608 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10609 after the operating system:
10610
10611 @smallexample
10612 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10613 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10614 Object Description
10615 any Any and all objects
10616 @end smallexample
10617
10618 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10619 by the kernel.
10620
10621 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10622 is supported other than to try it.
10623
10624
10625 @node Remote Debugging
10626 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10627
10628 @menu
10629 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
10630 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10631 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10632 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
10633 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10634 @end menu
10635
10636 @node Connecting
10637 @section Connecting to a remote target
10638
10639 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
10640 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
10641 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
10642 program as the first argument.
10643
10644 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10645 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
10646 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
10647 before the @code{target} command.
10648
10649 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
10650 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
10651 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
10652 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
10653 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
10654 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10655
10656 @smallexample
10657 target remote /dev/ttyb
10658 @end smallexample
10659
10660 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10661 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10662 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10663 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10664 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10665
10666 @smallexample
10667 target remote manyfarms:2828
10668 @end smallexample
10669
10670 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10671 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10672 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10673 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10674
10675 @smallexample
10676 target remote :1234
10677 @end smallexample
10678 @noindent
10679
10680 Note that the colon is still required here.
10681
10682 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10683 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10684 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10685 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10686
10687 @smallexample
10688 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10689 @end smallexample
10690
10691 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10692 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10693 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10694 session.
10695
10696 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10697 step and continue the remote program.
10698
10699 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10700 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10701 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10702 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10703 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10704 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10705 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10706
10707 @smallexample
10708 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10709 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10710 @end smallexample
10711
10712 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10713 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10714 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10715 goes back to waiting.
10716
10717 @table @code
10718 @kindex detach (remote)
10719 @item detach
10720 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
10721 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
10722 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
10723 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
10724 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
10725
10726 @kindex disconnect
10727 @item disconnect
10728 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
10729 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
10730 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
10731 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
10732 another target.
10733 @end table
10734
10735 @node Server
10736 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10737
10738 @kindex gdbserver
10739 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10740 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10741 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10742 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10743
10744 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10745 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10746 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10747 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10748 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10749 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10750 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10751 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10752 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10753 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10754 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10755 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10756 choice for debugging.
10757
10758 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10759 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10760 protocol.
10761
10762 @table @emph
10763 @item On the target machine,
10764 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10765 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10766 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10767 system does all the symbol handling.
10768
10769 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10770 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10771 syntax is:
10772
10773 @smallexample
10774 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10775 @end smallexample
10776
10777 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10778 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10779 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10780 @file{/dev/com1}:
10781
10782 @smallexample
10783 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10784 @end smallexample
10785
10786 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10787 with it.
10788
10789 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10790
10791 @smallexample
10792 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10793 @end smallexample
10794
10795 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10796 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10797 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10798 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10799 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10800 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10801 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10802 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10803 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10804 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10805 @code{target remote} command.
10806
10807 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10808 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10809
10810 @smallexample
10811 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10812 @end smallexample
10813
10814 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10815 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10816
10817 @pindex pidof
10818 @cindex attach to a program by name
10819 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
10820 @code{pidof} utility:
10821
10822 @smallexample
10823 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
10824 @end smallexample
10825
10826 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
10827 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
10828 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
10829
10830 @item On the host machine,
10831 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
10832 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10833 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10834 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10835 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
10836 command in @value{GDBN} when using gdbserver, since the program is
10837 already on the target.
10838
10839 @end table
10840
10841 @node NetWare
10842 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10843
10844 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10845 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10846 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10847 @code{target remote}.
10848
10849 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10850 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10851
10852 @table @emph
10853 @item On the target machine,
10854 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10855 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10856 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10857 host system does all the symbol handling.
10858
10859 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10860 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10861 program. The syntax is:
10862
10863 @smallexample
10864 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10865 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10866 @end smallexample
10867
10868 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10869 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10870 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10871
10872 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10873 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10874 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10875
10876 @smallexample
10877 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10878 @end smallexample
10879
10880 @item
10881 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
10882 Connecting to a remote target}).
10883
10884 @end table
10885
10886 @node Remote configuration
10887 @section Remote configuration
10888
10889 The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10890 programs:
10891
10892 @table @code
10893 @kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10894 @kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10895 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10896 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10897 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10898 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10899 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10900 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10901 @end table
10902
10903 @node remote stub
10904 @section Implementing a remote stub
10905
10906 @cindex debugging stub, example
10907 @cindex remote stub, example
10908 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10909 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10910 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10911 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10912 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10913 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10914 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10915 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10916
10917 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10918 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10919 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10920 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10921 program, you need:
10922
10923 @enumerate
10924 @item
10925 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10926 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10927 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10928
10929 @item
10930 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10931 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10932
10933 @item
10934 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10935 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10936 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10937 documentation.
10938 @end enumerate
10939
10940 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10941 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10942 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10943
10944 @table @emph
10945 @item On the host,
10946 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10947 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10948 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10949
10950 @item On the target,
10951 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10952 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10953 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10954
10955 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10956 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10957 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10958 @end table
10959
10960 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10961 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10962 @sc{sparc} boards.
10963
10964 @cindex remote serial stub list
10965 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10966
10967 @table @code
10968
10969 @item i386-stub.c
10970 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10971 @cindex Intel
10972 @cindex i386
10973 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10974
10975 @item m68k-stub.c
10976 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10977 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10978 @cindex m680x0
10979 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10980
10981 @item sh-stub.c
10982 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10983 @cindex Renesas
10984 @cindex SH
10985 For Renesas SH architectures.
10986
10987 @item sparc-stub.c
10988 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10989 @cindex Sparc
10990 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10991
10992 @item sparcl-stub.c
10993 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10994 @cindex Fujitsu
10995 @cindex SparcLite
10996 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10997
10998 @end table
10999
11000 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
11001 recently added stubs.
11002
11003 @menu
11004 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
11005 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
11006 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
11007 @end menu
11008
11009 @node Stub Contents
11010 @subsection What the stub can do for you
11011
11012 @cindex remote serial stub
11013 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
11014 subroutines:
11015
11016 @table @code
11017 @item set_debug_traps
11018 @kindex set_debug_traps
11019 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
11020 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
11021 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
11022 beginning of your program.
11023
11024 @item handle_exception
11025 @kindex handle_exception
11026 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
11027 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
11028 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
11029 run when a trap is triggered.
11030
11031 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
11032 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
11033 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
11034 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
11035 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
11036 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
11037 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
11038 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
11039 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
11040 machine.
11041
11042 @item breakpoint
11043 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
11044 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
11045 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
11046 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
11047 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
11048 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
11049 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
11050 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
11051 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
11052 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
11053 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
11054
11055 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
11056 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
11057 start of your debugging session.
11058 @end table
11059
11060 @node Bootstrapping
11061 @subsection What you must do for the stub
11062
11063 @cindex remote stub, support routines
11064 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
11065 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
11066 debugging target machine.
11067
11068 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
11069 serial port.
11070
11071 @table @code
11072 @item int getDebugChar()
11073 @kindex getDebugChar
11074 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
11075 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
11076 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11077
11078 @item void putDebugChar(int)
11079 @kindex putDebugChar
11080 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
11081 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
11082 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11083 @end table
11084
11085 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
11086 @cindex interrupting remote targets
11087 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
11088 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
11089 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
11090 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
11091 remote system to stop.
11092
11093 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
11094 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
11095 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
11096 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
11097
11098 Other routines you need to supply are:
11099
11100 @table @code
11101 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
11102 @kindex exceptionHandler
11103 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
11104 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
11105 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
11106 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
11107 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
11108 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
11109 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
11110 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
11111 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
11112 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
11113 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
11114 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
11115 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
11116
11117 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
11118 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
11119 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
11120 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
11121 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
11122
11123 @item void flush_i_cache()
11124 @kindex flush_i_cache
11125 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
11126 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
11127 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
11128
11129 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
11130 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
11131 @end table
11132
11133 @noindent
11134 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
11135
11136 @table @code
11137 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
11138 @kindex memset
11139 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
11140 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
11141 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11142 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11143 @end table
11144
11145 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11146 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11147 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
11148 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
11149
11150
11151 @node Debug Session
11152 @subsection Putting it all together
11153
11154 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
11155 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11156 steps.
11157
11158 @enumerate
11159 @item
11160 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
11161 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11162 @display
11163 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11164 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11165 @end display
11166
11167 @item
11168 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11169
11170 @smallexample
11171 set_debug_traps();
11172 breakpoint();
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 @item
11176 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11177 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11178
11179 @smallexample
11180 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
11181 @end smallexample
11182
11183 @noindent
11184 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
11185 function in your program, that function is called when
11186 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11187 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11188 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11189
11190 @item
11191 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11192 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11193
11194 @item
11195 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11196 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11197
11198 @item
11199 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11200 @c document that. FIXME.
11201 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11202 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11203
11204 @item
11205 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
11206 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
11207
11208 @end enumerate
11209
11210 @node Configurations
11211 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
11212
11213 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11214 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11215 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
11216
11217 There are three major categories of configurations: native
11218 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11219 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11220 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11221 are quite different from each other.
11222
11223 @menu
11224 * Native::
11225 * Embedded OS::
11226 * Embedded Processors::
11227 * Architectures::
11228 @end menu
11229
11230 @node Native
11231 @section Native
11232
11233 This section describes details specific to particular native
11234 configurations.
11235
11236 @menu
11237 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
11238 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11239 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
11240 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
11241 @end menu
11242
11243 @node HP-UX
11244 @subsection HP-UX
11245
11246 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11247 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11248 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
11249
11250 @node SVR4 Process Information
11251 @subsection SVR4 process information
11252
11253 @kindex /proc
11254 @cindex process image
11255
11256 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11257 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11258 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11259 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11260 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11261 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11262 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11263 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
11264
11265 @table @code
11266 @kindex info proc
11267 @item info proc
11268 Summarize available information about the process.
11269
11270 @kindex info proc mappings
11271 @item info proc mappings
11272 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11273 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11274 @ignore
11275 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11276 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11277 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11278 @kindex info proc times
11279 @item info proc times
11280 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11281 its children.
11282
11283 @kindex info proc id
11284 @item info proc id
11285 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11286 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11287
11288 @kindex info proc status
11289 @item info proc status
11290 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11291 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11292 received.
11293
11294 @item info proc all
11295 Show all the above information about the process.
11296 @end ignore
11297 @end table
11298
11299 @node DJGPP Native
11300 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11301 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11302 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11303 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11304
11305 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11306 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11307 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11308 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11309
11310 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11311 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11312 subsection describes those commands.
11313
11314 @table @code
11315 @kindex info dos
11316 @item info dos
11317 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11318 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11319
11320 @kindex sysinfo
11321 @cindex MS-DOS system info
11322 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11323 @item info dos sysinfo
11324 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11325 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11326 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11327
11328 @cindex GDT
11329 @cindex LDT
11330 @cindex IDT
11331 @cindex segment descriptor tables
11332 @cindex descriptor tables display
11333 @item info dos gdt
11334 @itemx info dos ldt
11335 @itemx info dos idt
11336 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11337 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11338 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11339 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11340 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11341 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11342 rights.
11343
11344 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11345 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11346 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11347 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11348 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11349
11350 @cindex garbled pointers
11351 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11352 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11353 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11354 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11355 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11356 debugged program's data segment:
11357
11358 @smallexample
11359 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11360 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11361 @end smallexample
11362
11363 @noindent
11364 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11365 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11366
11367 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11368 @item info dos pde
11369 @itemx info dos pte
11370 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11371 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11372 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11373 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11374 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11375 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11376 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11377 that is currently in use.
11378
11379 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11380 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11381 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11382 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11383 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11384 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11385 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11386
11387 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11388 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11389 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11390 controller.
11391
11392 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11393
11394 @cindex physical address from linear address
11395 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11396 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11397 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11398 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11399 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11400 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11401 the variable @code{i} is stored:
11402
11403 @smallexample
11404 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11405 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11406 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11407 @end smallexample
11408
11409 @noindent
11410 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11411 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11412 attributes of that page.
11413
11414 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11415 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11416 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11417 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11418 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11419 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11420
11421 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11422 transfer buffer:
11423
11424 @smallexample
11425 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11426 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11427 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11428 @end smallexample
11429
11430 @noindent
11431 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
11432 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11433 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11434 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11435
11436 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11437 @end table
11438
11439 @node Cygwin Native
11440 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11441 @cindex MS Windows debugging
11442 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
11443 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11444
11445 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11446 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11447 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11448 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11449 that have no debugging symbols.
11450
11451
11452 @table @code
11453 @kindex info w32
11454 @item info w32
11455 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11456 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11457
11458 @item info w32 selector
11459 This command displays information returned by
11460 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11461 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11462 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11463 Without argument, this command displays information
11464 about the the six segment registers.
11465
11466 @kindex info dll
11467 @item info dll
11468 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11469
11470 @kindex dll-symbols
11471 @item dll-symbols
11472 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11473 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11474
11475 @kindex set new-console
11476 @item set new-console @var{mode}
11477 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11478 be started in a new console on next start.
11479 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11480 be started in the same console as the debugger.
11481
11482 @kindex show new-console
11483 @item show new-console
11484 Displays whether a new console is used
11485 when the debuggee is started.
11486
11487 @kindex set new-group
11488 @item set new-group @var{mode}
11489 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11490 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11491 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11492 Ctrl-C.
11493
11494 @kindex show new-group
11495 @item show new-group
11496 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11497
11498 @kindex set debugevents
11499 @item set debugevents
11500 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11501
11502 @kindex set debugexec
11503 @item set debugexec
11504 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11505 seen by the debugger.
11506
11507 @kindex set debugexceptions
11508 @item set debugexceptions
11509 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11510 seen by the debugger.
11511
11512 @kindex set debugmemory
11513 @item set debugmemory
11514 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11515 seen by the debugger.
11516
11517 @kindex set shell
11518 @item set shell
11519 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11520 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11521
11522 @kindex show shell
11523 @item show shell
11524 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11525
11526 @end table
11527
11528 @menu
11529 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11530 @end menu
11531
11532 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
11533 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11534 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11535 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11536
11537 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11538 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11539 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11540 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11541 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11542 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11543 ``minimal symbols''.
11544
11545 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11546 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11547 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11548 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11549 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11550 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11551 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11552 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11553 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11554 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11555
11556 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11557
11558 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11559 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11560 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11561 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11562 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11563 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11564 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11565 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11566 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11567
11568 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11569 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11570 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11571 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11572 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11573 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11574
11575 @smallexample
11576 (gdb) info function CreateFileA
11577 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11578
11579 Non-debugging symbols:
11580 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
11581 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11582 @end smallexample
11583
11584 @smallexample
11585 (gdb) info function !
11586 All functions matching regular expression "!":
11587
11588 Non-debugging symbols:
11589 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
11590 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
11591 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11592 [etc...]
11593 @end smallexample
11594
11595 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11596
11597 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11598 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11599 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11600 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11601 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11602 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11603 a function within a DLL without a running program.
11604
11605 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11606 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11607 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11608 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11609 problem:
11610
11611 @smallexample
11612 (gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11613 $1 = 268572168
11614 @end smallexample
11615
11616 @smallexample
11617 (gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
11618 0x10021610: "\230y\""
11619 @end smallexample
11620
11621 And two possible solutions:
11622
11623 @smallexample
11624 (gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11625 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11626 @end smallexample
11627
11628 @smallexample
11629 (gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
11630 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11631 (gdb) x/x 0x10021608
11632 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11633 (gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
11634 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11635 @end smallexample
11636
11637 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11638 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11639 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11640 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11641 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11642
11643 @smallexample
11644 (gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11645 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11646 @end smallexample
11647
11648 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11649 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11650 safe.
11651
11652 @node Embedded OS
11653 @section Embedded Operating Systems
11654
11655 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11656 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11657 architectures.
11658
11659 @menu
11660 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11661 @end menu
11662
11663 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11664 various real-time operating systems.
11665
11666 @node VxWorks
11667 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11668
11669 @cindex VxWorks
11670
11671 @table @code
11672
11673 @kindex target vxworks
11674 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11675 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11676 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11677
11678 @end table
11679
11680 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11681 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11682
11683 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11684 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11685 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11686 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11687 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11688 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11689 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11690
11691 @table @code
11692 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11693 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11694 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11695 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11696 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11697 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11698 of a thin network line.
11699 @end table
11700
11701 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11702 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11703 procedures.
11704
11705 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11706 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11707 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11708 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11709 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11710 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11711 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11712 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11713 manual.
11714 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11715
11716 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11717 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11718 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11719 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11720
11721 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11722
11723 @smallexample
11724 (vxgdb)
11725 @end smallexample
11726
11727 @menu
11728 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11729 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11730 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11731 @end menu
11732
11733 @node VxWorks Connection
11734 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11735
11736 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11737 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11738
11739 @smallexample
11740 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11741 @end smallexample
11742
11743 @need 750
11744 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11745
11746 @smallexample
11747 Attaching remote machine across net...
11748 Connected to tt.
11749 @end smallexample
11750
11751 @need 1000
11752 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11753 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11754 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11755 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11756 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11757
11758 @smallexample
11759 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11760 @end smallexample
11761
11762 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11763 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11764 command again.
11765
11766 @node VxWorks Download
11767 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11768
11769 @cindex download to VxWorks
11770 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11771 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11772 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11773 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11774 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11775 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11776 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11777 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11778 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11779 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11780 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11781 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11782 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11783 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11784 program, type this on VxWorks:
11785
11786 @smallexample
11787 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11788 @end smallexample
11789
11790 @noindent
11791 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11792
11793 @smallexample
11794 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11795 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11796 @end smallexample
11797
11798 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11799
11800 @smallexample
11801 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11802 @end smallexample
11803
11804 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11805 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11806 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11807 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11808 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11809 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11810 table.)
11811
11812 @node VxWorks Attach
11813 @subsubsection Running tasks
11814
11815 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11816 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11817 follows:
11818
11819 @smallexample
11820 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11821 @end smallexample
11822
11823 @noindent
11824 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11825 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11826 the time of attachment.
11827
11828 @node Embedded Processors
11829 @section Embedded Processors
11830
11831 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11832 configurations.
11833
11834
11835 @menu
11836 * ARM:: ARM
11837 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
11838 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
11839 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
11840 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11841 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11842 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
11843 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11844 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11845 * SH:: Renesas SH
11846 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11847 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11848 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11849 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11850 @end menu
11851
11852 @node ARM
11853 @subsection ARM
11854
11855 @table @code
11856
11857 @kindex target rdi
11858 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11859 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11860 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11861 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11862
11863 @kindex target rdp
11864 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11865 ARM Demon monitor.
11866
11867 @end table
11868
11869 @node H8/300
11870 @subsection Renesas H8/300
11871
11872 @table @code
11873
11874 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11875 @item target hms @var{dev}
11876 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11877 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11878 line and the communications speed used.
11879
11880 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11881 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11882 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
11883
11884 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11885 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11886 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11887 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11888 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11889
11890 @end table
11891
11892 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11893 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11894 @cindex download to Renesas SH
11895 @cindex Renesas SH download
11896 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11897 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
11898 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11899 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11900
11901 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11902 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11903
11904 @enumerate
11905 @item
11906 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11907 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11908 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11909 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
11910 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11911
11912 @item
11913 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
11914 serial device available on your host is the default).
11915
11916 @item
11917 what speed to use over the serial device.
11918 @end enumerate
11919
11920 @menu
11921 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
11922 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11923 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
11924 @end menu
11925
11926 @node Renesas Boards
11927 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
11928
11929 @c only for Unix hosts
11930 @kindex device
11931 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
11932 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11933 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11934 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11935 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11936
11937 @kindex speed
11938 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
11939 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11940 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11941 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11942 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11943 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11944
11945 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11946 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
11947 use a DOS host,
11948 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11949 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11950 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11951 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11952
11953 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11954 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11955 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11956 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
11957
11958 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11959 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11960 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11961 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11962 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11963 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11964 @code{COM2}.
11965
11966 @smallexample
11967 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11968 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11969
11970 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11971
11972 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11973
11974 @end smallexample
11975
11976 @quotation
11977 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11978 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11979 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11980 your development board.
11981 @end quotation
11982
11983 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11984 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11985 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11986 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11987 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11988 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11989 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
11990 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11991 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11992 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11993 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11994 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11995 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11996
11997 @smallexample
11998 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11999 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
12000 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
12001 the conditions.
12002 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
12003 for details.
12004 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
12005 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
12006 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
12007 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
12008 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
12009 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
12010 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
12011 @end smallexample
12012
12013 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
12014 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
12015 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
12016 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
12017 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
12018 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
12019
12020 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
12021 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
12022 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
12023
12024 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
12025 @itemize @bullet
12026 @item
12027 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
12028 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
12029
12030 @item
12031 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
12032 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
12033 to detect program completion.
12034 @end itemize
12035
12036 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
12037 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
12038
12039 @node Renesas ICE
12040 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
12041
12042 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
12043 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
12044 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
12045 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
12046
12047 @table @code
12048 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
12049 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
12050 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
12051 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
12052 (for example, @samp{9600}).
12053
12054 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
12055 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
12056 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
12057 @end table
12058
12059 @node Renesas Special
12060 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
12061
12062 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
12063
12064 @table @code
12065
12066 @kindex set machine
12067 @kindex show machine
12068 @item set machine h8300
12069 @itemx set machine h8300h
12070 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
12071 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
12072 to check which variant is currently in effect.
12073
12074 @end table
12075
12076 @node H8/500
12077 @subsection H8/500
12078
12079 @table @code
12080
12081 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
12082 @cindex memory models, H8/500
12083 @item set memory @var{mod}
12084 @itemx show memory
12085 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
12086 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
12087 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
12088 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
12089
12090 @end table
12091
12092 @node M32R/D
12093 @subsection Renesas M32R/D
12094
12095 @table @code
12096
12097 @kindex target m32r
12098 @item target m32r @var{dev}
12099 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
12100
12101 @end table
12102
12103 @node M68K
12104 @subsection M68k
12105
12106 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12107 target command for the following ROM monitors.
12108
12109 @table @code
12110
12111 @kindex target abug
12112 @item target abug @var{dev}
12113 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12114
12115 @kindex target cpu32bug
12116 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12117 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12118
12119 @kindex target dbug
12120 @item target dbug @var{dev}
12121 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12122
12123 @kindex target est
12124 @item target est @var{dev}
12125 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12126
12127 @kindex target rom68k
12128 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
12129 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12130
12131 @end table
12132
12133 @table @code
12134
12135 @kindex target rombug
12136 @item target rombug @var{dev}
12137 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12138
12139 @end table
12140
12141 @node MIPS Embedded
12142 @subsection MIPS Embedded
12143
12144 @cindex MIPS boards
12145 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12146 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12147 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
12148
12149 @need 1000
12150 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
12151
12152 @table @code
12153 @item target mips @var{port}
12154 @kindex target mips @var{port}
12155 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12156 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12157 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12158 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12159 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12160 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
12161
12162 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12163 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12164 debugger:
12165
12166 @smallexample
12167 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12168 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12169 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12170 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12171 (@value{GDBP}) run
12172 @end smallexample
12173
12174 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12175 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12176 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12177 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12178 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12179
12180 @item target pmon @var{port}
12181 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
12182 PMON ROM monitor.
12183
12184 @item target ddb @var{port}
12185 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
12186 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
12187
12188 @item target lsi @var{port}
12189 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
12190 LSI variant of PMON.
12191
12192 @kindex target r3900
12193 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
12194 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
12195
12196 @kindex target array
12197 @item target array @var{dev}
12198 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
12199
12200 @end table
12201
12202
12203 @noindent
12204 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
12205
12206 @table @code
12207 @item set processor @var{args}
12208 @itemx show processor
12209 @kindex set processor @var{args}
12210 @kindex show processor
12211 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12212 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12213 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12214 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12215 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12216 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12217 @value{GDBN} is using.
12218
12219 @item set mipsfpu double
12220 @itemx set mipsfpu single
12221 @itemx set mipsfpu none
12222 @itemx show mipsfpu
12223 @kindex set mipsfpu
12224 @kindex show mipsfpu
12225 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
12226 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12227 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12228 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12229 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12230 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12231 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12232 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12233 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12234 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12235 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12236 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12237 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12238
12239 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12240 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12241 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12242
12243 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12244 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
12245
12246 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
12247 @itemx show remotedebug
12248 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12249 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12250 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12251 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12252 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12253 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12254 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12255 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12256 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12257 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12258 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12259
12260 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
12261 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12262 @itemx show timeout
12263 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
12264 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12265 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12266 @kindex set timeout
12267 @kindex show timeout
12268 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
12269 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
12270 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12271 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12272 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12273 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12274 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12275 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12276 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12277 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12278
12279 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12280 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12281 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12282 to run before stopping.
12283 @end table
12284
12285 @node OpenRISC 1000
12286 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
12287 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
12288
12289 @cindex or1k boards
12290 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12291 about platform and commands.
12292
12293 @table @code
12294
12295 @kindex target jtag
12296 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12297
12298 Connects to remote JTAG server.
12299 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12300 connected via parallel port to the board.
12301
12302 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12303
12304 @kindex or1ksim
12305 @item or1ksim @var{command}
12306 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12307 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12308
12309 @kindex info or1k spr
12310 @item info or1k spr
12311 Displays spr groups.
12312
12313 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
12314 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12315 Displays register names in selected group.
12316
12317 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12318 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12319 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12320 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12321 Shows information about specified spr register.
12322
12323 @kindex spr
12324 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12325 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12326 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12327 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12328 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12329 @end table
12330
12331 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12332 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12333 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12334 triggers can be set using:
12335 @table @code
12336 @item $LEA/$LDATA
12337 Load effective address/data
12338 @item $SEA/$SDATA
12339 Store effective address/data
12340 @item $AEA/$ADATA
12341 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12342 @item $FETCH
12343 Fetch data
12344 @end table
12345
12346 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12347 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12348
12349 @code{htrace} commands:
12350 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12351 @table @code
12352 @kindex hwatch
12353 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
12354 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12355 or Data. For example:
12356
12357 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12358
12359 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12360
12361 @kindex htrace info
12362 @item htrace info
12363 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12364
12365 @kindex htrace trigger
12366 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12367 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12368
12369 @kindex htrace qualifier
12370 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12371 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12372
12373 @kindex htrace stop
12374 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12375 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12376
12377 @kindex htrace record
12378 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
12379 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12380 triggered.
12381
12382 @kindex htrace enable
12383 @item htrace enable
12384 @kindex htrace disable
12385 @itemx htrace disable
12386 Enables/disables the HW trace.
12387
12388 @kindex htrace rewind
12389 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
12390 Clears currently recorded trace data.
12391
12392 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12393 will be written there.
12394
12395 @kindex htrace print
12396 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
12397 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12398
12399 @kindex htrace mode continuous
12400 @item htrace mode continuous
12401 Set continuous trace mode.
12402
12403 @kindex htrace mode suspend
12404 @item htrace mode suspend
12405 Set suspend trace mode.
12406
12407 @end table
12408
12409 @node PowerPC
12410 @subsection PowerPC
12411
12412 @table @code
12413
12414 @kindex target dink32
12415 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
12416 DINK32 ROM monitor.
12417
12418 @kindex target ppcbug
12419 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12420 @kindex target ppcbug1
12421 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12422 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12423
12424 @kindex target sds
12425 @item target sds @var{dev}
12426 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12427
12428 @end table
12429
12430 @node PA
12431 @subsection HP PA Embedded
12432
12433 @table @code
12434
12435 @kindex target op50n
12436 @item target op50n @var{dev}
12437 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12438
12439 @kindex target w89k
12440 @item target w89k @var{dev}
12441 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12442
12443 @end table
12444
12445 @node SH
12446 @subsection Renesas SH
12447
12448 @table @code
12449
12450 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
12451 @item target hms @var{dev}
12452 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12453 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12454 the communications speed used.
12455
12456 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
12457 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
12458 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
12459
12460 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12461 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12462 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
12463 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
12464 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12465
12466 @end table
12467
12468 @node Sparclet
12469 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12470
12471 @cindex Sparclet
12472
12473 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12474 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12475 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12476 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12477 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
12478
12479 @table @code
12480 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
12481 @kindex remotetimeout
12482 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12483 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12484 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
12485 @end table
12486
12487 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12488 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12489 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12490 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12491 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
12492
12493 @smallexample
12494 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12495 @end smallexample
12496
12497 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
12498
12499 @smallexample
12500 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12501 @end smallexample
12502
12503 @cindex running, on Sparclet
12504 Once you have set
12505 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12506 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12507 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12508
12509 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12510
12511 @smallexample
12512 (gdbslet)
12513 @end smallexample
12514
12515 @menu
12516 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12517 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12518 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12519 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
12520 @end menu
12521
12522 @node Sparclet File
12523 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
12524
12525 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12526
12527 @smallexample
12528 (gdbslet) file prog
12529 @end smallexample
12530
12531 @need 1000
12532 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12533 @value{GDBN} locates
12534 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12535 path.
12536 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12537 files will be searched as well.
12538 @value{GDBN} locates
12539 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12540 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12541 If it fails
12542 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12543
12544 @smallexample
12545 prog: No such file or directory.
12546 @end smallexample
12547
12548 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12549 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12550 @code{target} command again.
12551
12552 @node Sparclet Connection
12553 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12554
12555 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12556 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12557
12558 @smallexample
12559 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12560 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12561 main () at ../prog.c:3
12562 @end smallexample
12563
12564 @need 750
12565 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12566
12567 @smallexample
12568 Connected to ttya.
12569 @end smallexample
12570
12571 @node Sparclet Download
12572 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12573
12574 @cindex download to Sparclet
12575 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12576 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12577 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12578 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12579 command.
12580 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12581 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12582 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12583 of each of the file's sections.
12584 For instance, if the program
12585 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12586 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12587
12588 @smallexample
12589 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12590 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12591 @end smallexample
12592
12593 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12594 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12595 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12596
12597 @node Sparclet Execution
12598 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12599
12600 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12601 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12602 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12603 manual for the list of commands.
12604
12605 @smallexample
12606 (gdbslet) b main
12607 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12608 (gdbslet) run
12609 Starting program: prog
12610 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12611 3 char *symarg = 0;
12612 (gdbslet) step
12613 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12614 (gdbslet)
12615 @end smallexample
12616
12617 @node Sparclite
12618 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12619
12620 @table @code
12621
12622 @kindex target sparclite
12623 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12624 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12625 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12626 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12627 remote protocol.
12628
12629 @end table
12630
12631 @node ST2000
12632 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12633
12634 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12635 STDBUG protocol.
12636
12637 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12638 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12639
12640 @smallexample
12641 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12642 @end smallexample
12643
12644 @noindent
12645 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12646 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12647 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12648 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12649 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12650
12651 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12652 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12653 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12654 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12655 available on your host computer.
12656 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12657 @c basically hearsay.
12658
12659 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12660 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12661 environment:
12662
12663 @table @code
12664 @item st2000 @var{command}
12665 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12666 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12667 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12668 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12669 manual for available commands.
12670
12671 @item connect
12672 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12673 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12674 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12675 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12676 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12677 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12678 @end table
12679
12680 @node Z8000
12681 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12682
12683 @cindex Z8000
12684 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12685 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12686
12687 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12688 a Z8000 simulator.
12689
12690 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12691 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12692 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12693 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12694
12695 @table @code
12696 @item target sim @var{args}
12697 @kindex sim
12698 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12699 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12700 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12701 @end table
12702
12703 @noindent
12704 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12705 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12706 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12707 to run your program, and so on.
12708
12709 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12710 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12711 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12712
12713 @table @code
12714
12715 @item cycles
12716 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12717
12718 @item insts
12719 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12720
12721 @item time
12722 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12723
12724 @end table
12725
12726 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12727 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12728 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12729 simulated clock ticks.
12730
12731 @node Architectures
12732 @section Architectures
12733
12734 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12735 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12736
12737 @menu
12738 * A29K::
12739 * Alpha::
12740 * MIPS::
12741 @end menu
12742
12743 @node A29K
12744 @subsection A29K
12745
12746 @table @code
12747
12748 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12749 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12750 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12751 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12752 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12753 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12754 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12755 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12756 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12757 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12758 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12759 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12760 hexadecimal.
12761
12762 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12763 @item show rstack_high_address
12764 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12765 processors.
12766
12767 @end table
12768
12769 @node Alpha
12770 @subsection Alpha
12771
12772 See the following section.
12773
12774 @node MIPS
12775 @subsection MIPS
12776
12777 @cindex stack on Alpha
12778 @cindex stack on MIPS
12779 @cindex Alpha stack
12780 @cindex MIPS stack
12781 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12782 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12783 find the beginning of a function.
12784
12785 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12786 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12787 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12788 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12789 commands:
12790
12791 @table @code
12792 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12793 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12794 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12795 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12796 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12797 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12798 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12799
12800 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12801 Display the current limit.
12802 @end table
12803
12804 @noindent
12805 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12806 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12807
12808
12809 @node Controlling GDB
12810 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12811
12812 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12813 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12814 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12815 described here.
12816
12817 @menu
12818 * Prompt:: Prompt
12819 * Editing:: Command editing
12820 * History:: Command history
12821 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12822 * Numbers:: Numbers
12823 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
12824 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12825 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12826 @end menu
12827
12828 @node Prompt
12829 @section Prompt
12830
12831 @cindex prompt
12832
12833 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12834 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12835 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12836 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12837 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12838 which one you are talking to.
12839
12840 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12841 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12842 or a prompt that does not.
12843
12844 @table @code
12845 @kindex set prompt
12846 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12847 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12848
12849 @kindex show prompt
12850 @item show prompt
12851 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12852 @end table
12853
12854 @node Editing
12855 @section Command editing
12856 @cindex readline
12857 @cindex command line editing
12858
12859 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12860 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12861 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12862 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12863 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12864 debugging sessions.
12865
12866 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12867 command @code{set}.
12868
12869 @table @code
12870 @kindex set editing
12871 @cindex editing
12872 @item set editing
12873 @itemx set editing on
12874 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12875
12876 @item set editing off
12877 Disable command line editing.
12878
12879 @kindex show editing
12880 @item show editing
12881 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12882 @end table
12883
12884 @node History
12885 @section Command history
12886
12887 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12888 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12889 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12890 history facility.
12891
12892 @table @code
12893 @cindex history substitution
12894 @cindex history file
12895 @kindex set history filename
12896 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12897 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12898 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12899 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12900 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12901 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12902 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12903 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12904 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12905 is not set.
12906
12907 @cindex history save
12908 @kindex set history save
12909 @item set history save
12910 @itemx set history save on
12911 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12912 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12913
12914 @item set history save off
12915 Stop recording command history in a file.
12916
12917 @cindex history size
12918 @kindex set history size
12919 @item set history size @var{size}
12920 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12921 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12922 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12923 @end table
12924
12925 @cindex history expansion
12926 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12927 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12928 @xref{Event Designators}.
12929 @end ifset
12930
12931 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12932 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12933 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12934 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12935 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12936 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12937 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12938
12939 The commands to control history expansion are:
12940
12941 @table @code
12942 @kindex set history expansion
12943 @item set history expansion on
12944 @itemx set history expansion
12945 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12946
12947 @item set history expansion off
12948 Disable history expansion.
12949
12950 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12951 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12952 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12953 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12954 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12955 @end ifset
12956
12957 @c @group
12958 @kindex show history
12959 @item show history
12960 @itemx show history filename
12961 @itemx show history save
12962 @itemx show history size
12963 @itemx show history expansion
12964 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12965 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12966 @c @end group
12967 @end table
12968
12969 @table @code
12970 @kindex shows
12971 @item show commands
12972 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12973
12974 @item show commands @var{n}
12975 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12976
12977 @item show commands +
12978 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12979 @end table
12980
12981 @node Screen Size
12982 @section Screen size
12983 @cindex size of screen
12984 @cindex pauses in output
12985
12986 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12987 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12988 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12989 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12990 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12991 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12992 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12993 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12994
12995 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12996 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12997 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12998 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12999 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
13000 width} commands:
13001
13002 @table @code
13003 @kindex set height
13004 @kindex set width
13005 @kindex show width
13006 @kindex show height
13007 @item set height @var{lpp}
13008 @itemx show height
13009 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
13010 @itemx show width
13011 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
13012 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
13013 commands display the current settings.
13014
13015 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
13016 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
13017 file or to an editor buffer.
13018
13019 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
13020 from wrapping its output.
13021 @end table
13022
13023 @node Numbers
13024 @section Numbers
13025 @cindex number representation
13026 @cindex entering numbers
13027
13028 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
13029 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
13030 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
13031 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
13032 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
13033 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
13034 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
13035 radix} command.
13036
13037 @table @code
13038 @kindex set input-radix
13039 @item set input-radix @var{base}
13040 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
13041 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13042 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
13043 example, any of
13044
13045 @smallexample
13046 set radix 012
13047 set radix 10.
13048 set radix 0xa
13049 @end smallexample
13050
13051 @noindent
13052 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
13053 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
13054
13055 @kindex set output-radix
13056 @item set output-radix @var{base}
13057 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
13058 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13059 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
13060
13061 @kindex show input-radix
13062 @item show input-radix
13063 Display the current default base for numeric input.
13064
13065 @kindex show output-radix
13066 @item show output-radix
13067 Display the current default base for numeric display.
13068 @end table
13069
13070 @node ABI
13071 @section Configuring the current ABI
13072
13073 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
13074 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
13075 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
13076 current ABI.
13077
13078 @cindex OS ABI
13079 @kindex set osabi
13080 @kindex show osabi
13081
13082 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
13083 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
13084 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
13085 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
13086 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
13087 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
13088 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
13089 platform provides.
13090
13091 @table @code
13092 @item show osabi
13093 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
13094
13095 @item set osabi
13096 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
13097
13098 @item set osabi @var{abi}
13099 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
13100 @end table
13101
13102 @cindex float promotion
13103 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
13104
13105 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
13106 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
13107 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
13108 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
13109 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
13110 @code{double} and then passed.
13111
13112 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
13113 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
13114 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
13115
13116 @table @code
13117 @item set coerce-float-to-double
13118 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
13119 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
13120 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
13121
13122 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
13123 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
13124 functions.
13125 @end table
13126
13127 @kindex set cp-abi
13128 @kindex show cp-abi
13129 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
13130 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
13131 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
13132 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
13133 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
13134 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
13135 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
13136 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
13137 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
13138 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
13139 ``auto''.
13140
13141 @table @code
13142 @item show cp-abi
13143 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
13144
13145 @item set cp-abi
13146 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
13147
13148 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
13149 @itemx set cp-abi auto
13150 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
13151 @end table
13152
13153 @node Messages/Warnings
13154 @section Optional warnings and messages
13155
13156 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
13157 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
13158 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
13159 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
13160
13161 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
13162 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
13163 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
13164
13165 @table @code
13166 @kindex set verbose
13167 @item set verbose on
13168 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13169
13170 @item set verbose off
13171 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13172
13173 @kindex show verbose
13174 @item show verbose
13175 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
13176 @end table
13177
13178 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
13179 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
13180 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
13181 symbol files}).
13182
13183 @table @code
13184
13185 @kindex set complaints
13186 @item set complaints @var{limit}
13187 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
13188 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
13189 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
13190 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
13191
13192 @kindex show complaints
13193 @item show complaints
13194 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
13195
13196 @end table
13197
13198 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
13199 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
13200 you try to run a program which is already running:
13201
13202 @smallexample
13203 (@value{GDBP}) run
13204 The program being debugged has been started already.
13205 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
13206 @end smallexample
13207
13208 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
13209 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
13210
13211 @table @code
13212
13213 @kindex set confirm
13214 @cindex flinching
13215 @cindex confirmation
13216 @cindex stupid questions
13217 @item set confirm off
13218 Disables confirmation requests.
13219
13220 @item set confirm on
13221 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
13222
13223 @kindex show confirm
13224 @item show confirm
13225 Displays state of confirmation requests.
13226
13227 @end table
13228
13229 @node Debugging Output
13230 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
13231 @table @code
13232 @kindex set debug arch
13233 @item set debug arch
13234 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13235 @kindex show debug arch
13236 @item show debug arch
13237 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13238 @kindex set debug event
13239 @item set debug event
13240 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13241 default is off.
13242 @kindex show debug event
13243 @item show debug event
13244 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13245 info.
13246 @kindex set debug expression
13247 @item set debug expression
13248 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13249 default is off.
13250 @kindex show debug expression
13251 @item show debug expression
13252 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13253 debugging info.
13254 @kindex set debug frame
13255 @item set debug frame
13256 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
13257 default is off.
13258 @kindex show debug frame
13259 @item show debug frame
13260 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
13261 info.
13262 @kindex set debug overload
13263 @item set debug overload
13264 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13265 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13266 is off.
13267 @kindex show debug overload
13268 @item show debug overload
13269 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13270 debugging info.
13271 @kindex set debug remote
13272 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13273 @cindex serial connections, debugging
13274 @item set debug remote
13275 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13276 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13277 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13278 @kindex show debug remote
13279 @item show debug remote
13280 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13281 @kindex set debug serial
13282 @item set debug serial
13283 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13284 default is off.
13285 @kindex show debug serial
13286 @item show debug serial
13287 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13288 info.
13289 @kindex set debug target
13290 @item set debug target
13291 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13292 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13293 default is off.
13294 @kindex show debug target
13295 @item show debug target
13296 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13297 info.
13298 @kindex set debug varobj
13299 @item set debug varobj
13300 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13301 info. The default is off.
13302 @kindex show debug varobj
13303 @item show debug varobj
13304 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13305 debugging info.
13306 @end table
13307
13308 @node Sequences
13309 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13310
13311 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13312 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13313 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13314 files.
13315
13316 @menu
13317 * Define:: User-defined commands
13318 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13319 * Command Files:: Command files
13320 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
13321 @end menu
13322
13323 @node Define
13324 @section User-defined commands
13325
13326 @cindex user-defined command
13327 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13328 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13329 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13330 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13331 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
13332
13333 @smallexample
13334 define adder
13335 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13336 @end smallexample
13337
13338 @noindent
13339 To execute the command use:
13340
13341 @smallexample
13342 adder 1 2 3
13343 @end smallexample
13344
13345 @noindent
13346 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13347 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13348 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13349 functions calls.
13350
13351 @table @code
13352
13353 @kindex define
13354 @item define @var{commandname}
13355 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13356 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13357
13358 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13359 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13360 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13361
13362 @kindex if
13363 @kindex else
13364 @item if
13365 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13366 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13367 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13368 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13369 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13370 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13371
13372 @kindex while
13373 @item while
13374 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13375 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13376 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13377 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13378 evaluates to true.
13379
13380 @kindex document
13381 @item document @var{commandname}
13382 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13383 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13384 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13385 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13386 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13387 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13388
13389 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13390 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13391 does not change the documentation.
13392
13393 @kindex help user-defined
13394 @item help user-defined
13395 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13396 (if any) for each.
13397
13398 @kindex show user
13399 @item show user
13400 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
13401 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13402 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13403 definitions for all user-defined commands.
13404
13405 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
13406 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
13407 @item show max-user-call-depth
13408 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
13409 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13410 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13411 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
13412
13413 @end table
13414
13415 When user-defined commands are executed, the
13416 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13417 stops execution of the user-defined command.
13418
13419 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13420 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13421 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13422 messages when used in a user-defined command.
13423
13424 @node Hooks
13425 @section User-defined command hooks
13426 @cindex command hooks
13427 @cindex hooks, for commands
13428 @cindex hooks, pre-command
13429
13430 @kindex hook
13431 @kindex hook-
13432 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13433 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13434 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13435 before that command.
13436
13437 @cindex hooks, post-command
13438 @kindex hookpost
13439 @kindex hookpost-
13440 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13441 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13442 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13443 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13444 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13445
13446 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13447 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13448
13449 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13450 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13451
13452 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13453 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13454 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13455 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13456 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13457
13458 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13459 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13460 you could define:
13461
13462 @smallexample
13463 define hook-stop
13464 handle SIGALRM nopass
13465 end
13466
13467 define hook-run
13468 handle SIGALRM pass
13469 end
13470
13471 define hook-continue
13472 handle SIGLARM pass
13473 end
13474 @end smallexample
13475
13476 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13477 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13478 you could define:
13479
13480 @smallexample
13481 define hook-echo
13482 echo <<<---
13483 end
13484
13485 define hookpost-echo
13486 echo --->>>\n
13487 end
13488
13489 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13490 <<<---Hello World--->>>
13491 (@value{GDBP})
13492
13493 @end smallexample
13494
13495 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13496 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13497 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13498 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13499 @c or not?
13500 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13501 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13502 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13503
13504 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13505 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13506
13507 @node Command Files
13508 @section Command files
13509
13510 @cindex command files
13511 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13512 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13513 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13514 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13515
13516 @cindex init file
13517 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13518 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13519 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13520 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13521 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13522 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13523 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
13524
13525 @enumerate
13526 @item
13527 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13528 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13529 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13530
13531 @item
13532 Processes command line options and operands.
13533
13534 @item
13535 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13536
13537 @item
13538 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13539 @end enumerate
13540
13541 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13542 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13543 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13544 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
13545
13546 @cindex init file name
13547 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13548 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13549 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13550 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13551 environments with special init file names:
13552
13553 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13554 @itemize @bullet
13555 @item
13556 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
13557
13558 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13559 @item
13560 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
13561
13562 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13563 @item
13564 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13565 @end itemize
13566
13567 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13568 @code{source} command:
13569
13570 @table @code
13571 @kindex source
13572 @item source @var{filename}
13573 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13574 @end table
13575
13576 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13577 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13578 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13579
13580 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13581 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13582 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13583 when called from command files.
13584
13585 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13586 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13587 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13588 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13589 the next command.
13590
13591 @smallexample
13592 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13593 @end smallexample
13594
13595 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13596 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13597 would be directed to @file{log}.
13598
13599 @node Output
13600 @section Commands for controlled output
13601
13602 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13603 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13604 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13605 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13606 want.
13607
13608 @table @code
13609 @kindex echo
13610 @item echo @var{text}
13611 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13612 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13613 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13614 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13615 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13616 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13617 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13618 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13619 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13620 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13621 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13622
13623 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13624 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13625
13626 @smallexample
13627 echo This is some text\n\
13628 which is continued\n\
13629 onto several lines.\n
13630 @end smallexample
13631
13632 produces the same output as
13633
13634 @smallexample
13635 echo This is some text\n
13636 echo which is continued\n
13637 echo onto several lines.\n
13638 @end smallexample
13639
13640 @kindex output
13641 @item output @var{expression}
13642 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13643 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13644 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13645 on expressions.
13646
13647 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13648 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13649 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13650 formats}, for more information.
13651
13652 @kindex printf
13653 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13654 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13655 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13656 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13657 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13658 subroutine
13659 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13660 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13661 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13662 @c supported.
13663
13664 @smallexample
13665 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13666 @end smallexample
13667
13668 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13669
13670 @smallexample
13671 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13672 @end smallexample
13673
13674 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13675 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13676 letter.
13677 @end table
13678
13679 @node Interpreters
13680 @chapter Command Interpreters
13681 @cindex command interpreters
13682
13683 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13684 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13685 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13686
13687 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13688 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13689 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13690 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13691
13692 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13693 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13694 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13695 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13696
13697 @table @code
13698 @item console
13699 @cindex console interpreter
13700 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13701 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13702 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13703
13704 @item mi
13705 @cindex mi interpreter
13706 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13707 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13708 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13709 Interface}.
13710
13711 @item mi2
13712 @cindex mi2 interpreter
13713 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13714
13715 @item mi1
13716 @cindex mi1 interpreter
13717 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13718
13719 @end table
13720
13721 @cindex invoke another interpreter
13722 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13723 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13724 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13725 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13726 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13727 the IDE inoperable!
13728
13729 @kindex interpreter-exec
13730 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13731 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13732 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13733 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
13734
13735 @smallexample
13736 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13737 @end smallexample
13738
13739 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13740 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13741
13742 @node TUI
13743 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13744 @cindex TUI
13745
13746 @menu
13747 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13748 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13749 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13750 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13751 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13752 @end menu
13753
13754 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13755 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13756 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13757 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13758 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13759 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13760
13761 @node TUI Overview
13762 @section TUI overview
13763
13764 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13765 @value{GDBN} runs:
13766
13767 @itemize @bullet
13768 @item
13769 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13770 windows on the terminal.
13771
13772 @item
13773 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13774 the TUI.
13775 @end itemize
13776
13777 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13778 on the terminal:
13779
13780 @table @emph
13781 @item command
13782 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13783 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13784 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13785 window is always visible.
13786
13787 @item source
13788 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13789 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13790
13791 @item assembly
13792 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13793
13794 @item register
13795 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13796 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13797 changed are highlighted.
13798
13799 @end table
13800
13801 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13802 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13803 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13804 indicates the breakpoint type:
13805
13806 @table @code
13807 @item B
13808 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13809
13810 @item b
13811 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13812
13813 @item H
13814 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13815
13816 @item h
13817 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13818
13819 @end table
13820
13821 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13822
13823 @table @code
13824 @item +
13825 Breakpoint is enabled.
13826
13827 @item -
13828 Breakpoint is disabled.
13829
13830 @end table
13831
13832 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13833 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13834 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13835 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13836 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13837 The following layouts are available:
13838
13839 @itemize @bullet
13840 @item
13841 source
13842
13843 @item
13844 assembly
13845
13846 @item
13847 source and assembly
13848
13849 @item
13850 source and registers
13851
13852 @item
13853 assembly and registers
13854
13855 @end itemize
13856
13857 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13858 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13859 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13860 are displayed:
13861
13862 @table @emph
13863 @item target
13864 Indicates the current gdb target
13865 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13866
13867 @item process
13868 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13869 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13870
13871 @item function
13872 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13873 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13874 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13875 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13876
13877 @item line
13878 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13879 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13880
13881 @item pc
13882 Indicates the current program counter address.
13883
13884 @end table
13885
13886 @node TUI Keys
13887 @section TUI Key Bindings
13888 @cindex TUI key bindings
13889
13890 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13891 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13892 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13893 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13894 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13895 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13896 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13897
13898 @table @kbd
13899 @kindex C-x C-a
13900 @item C-x C-a
13901 @kindex C-x a
13902 @itemx C-x a
13903 @kindex C-x A
13904 @itemx C-x A
13905 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13906 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13907 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13908 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13909 The screen is then refreshed.
13910
13911 @kindex C-x 1
13912 @item C-x 1
13913 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13914 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13915 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13916
13917 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13918
13919 @kindex C-x 2
13920 @item C-x 2
13921 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13922 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13923 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13924 previous layout and the new one.
13925
13926 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13927
13928 @kindex C-x o
13929 @item C-x o
13930 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
13931 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
13932 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
13933
13934 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
13935
13936 @kindex C-x s
13937 @item C-x s
13938 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13939 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13940
13941 @end table
13942
13943 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13944
13945 @table @key
13946 @kindex PgUp
13947 @item PgUp
13948 Scroll the active window one page up.
13949
13950 @kindex PgDn
13951 @item PgDn
13952 Scroll the active window one page down.
13953
13954 @kindex Up
13955 @item Up
13956 Scroll the active window one line up.
13957
13958 @kindex Down
13959 @item Down
13960 Scroll the active window one line down.
13961
13962 @kindex Left
13963 @item Left
13964 Scroll the active window one column left.
13965
13966 @kindex Right
13967 @item Right
13968 Scroll the active window one column right.
13969
13970 @kindex C-L
13971 @item C-L
13972 Refresh the screen.
13973
13974 @end table
13975
13976 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13977 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
13978 active window is the command window. When the command window
13979 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
13980 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13981
13982 @node TUI Single Key Mode
13983 @section TUI Single Key Mode
13984 @cindex TUI single key mode
13985
13986 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13987 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13988 some gdb commands.
13989
13990 @table @kbd
13991 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13992 @item c
13993 continue
13994
13995 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13996 @item d
13997 down
13998
13999 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14000 @item f
14001 finish
14002
14003 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14004 @item n
14005 next
14006
14007 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14008 @item q
14009 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
14010
14011 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14012 @item r
14013 run
14014
14015 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14016 @item s
14017 step
14018
14019 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14020 @item u
14021 up
14022
14023 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14024 @item v
14025 info locals
14026
14027 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14028 @item w
14029 where
14030
14031 @end table
14032
14033 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
14034 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
14035 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
14036 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
14037 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
14038 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
14039
14040
14041 @node TUI Commands
14042 @section TUI specific commands
14043 @cindex TUI commands
14044
14045 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
14046 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
14047 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
14048 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
14049 in the TUI mode.
14050
14051 @table @code
14052 @item info win
14053 @kindex info win
14054 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
14055
14056 @item layout next
14057 @kindex layout next
14058 Display the next layout.
14059
14060 @item layout prev
14061 @kindex layout prev
14062 Display the previous layout.
14063
14064 @item layout src
14065 @kindex layout src
14066 Display the source window only.
14067
14068 @item layout asm
14069 @kindex layout asm
14070 Display the assembly window only.
14071
14072 @item layout split
14073 @kindex layout split
14074 Display the source and assembly window.
14075
14076 @item layout regs
14077 @kindex layout regs
14078 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
14079
14080 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
14081 @kindex focus
14082 Set the focus to the named window.
14083 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
14084 can be affected to another window.
14085
14086 @item refresh
14087 @kindex refresh
14088 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
14089
14090 @item update
14091 @kindex update
14092 Update the source window and the current execution point.
14093
14094 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
14095 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
14096 @kindex winheight
14097 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
14098 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
14099 decrease it.
14100
14101 @end table
14102
14103 @node TUI Configuration
14104 @section TUI configuration variables
14105 @cindex TUI configuration variables
14106
14107 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
14108 appearance of windows on the terminal.
14109
14110 @table @code
14111 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
14112 @kindex set tui border-kind
14113 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
14114 The possible values are the following:
14115 @table @code
14116 @item space
14117 Use a space character to draw the border.
14118
14119 @item ascii
14120 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
14121
14122 @item acs
14123 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
14124 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
14125
14126 @end table
14127
14128 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
14129 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
14130 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
14131 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
14132 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
14133
14134 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
14135 @kindex set tui border-mode
14136 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
14137 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
14138 @table @code
14139 @item normal
14140 Use normal attributes to display the border.
14141
14142 @item standout
14143 Use standout mode.
14144
14145 @item reverse
14146 Use reverse video mode.
14147
14148 @item half
14149 Use half bright mode.
14150
14151 @item half-standout
14152 Use half bright and standout mode.
14153
14154 @item bold
14155 Use extra bright or bold mode.
14156
14157 @item bold-standout
14158 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
14159
14160 @end table
14161
14162 @end table
14163
14164 @node Emacs
14165 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
14166
14167 @cindex Emacs
14168 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
14169 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
14170 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
14171 @value{GDBN}.
14172
14173 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
14174 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
14175 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
14176 created Emacs buffer.
14177 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
14178
14179 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
14180 things:
14181
14182 @itemize @bullet
14183 @item
14184 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
14185 @end itemize
14186
14187 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
14188 and output done by the program you are debugging.
14189
14190 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
14191 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
14192 in this way.
14193
14194 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
14195 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
14196 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
14197 stop.
14198
14199 @itemize @bullet
14200 @item
14201 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
14202 @end itemize
14203
14204 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
14205 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
14206 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
14207 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
14208 and the source.
14209
14210 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
14211 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
14212
14213 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
14214 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
14215 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
14216 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
14217 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
14218 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
14219 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
14220 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
14221 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
14222
14223 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
14224 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
14225 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
14226 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
14227
14228 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
14229 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
14230 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
14231 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
14232 one you want.
14233
14234 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14235 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
14236
14237 @table @kbd
14238 @item C-h m
14239 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
14240
14241 @item C-c C-s
14242 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14243 update the display window to show the current file and location.
14244
14245 @item C-c C-n
14246 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14247 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14248 to show the current file and location.
14249
14250 @item C-c C-i
14251 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14252 display window accordingly.
14253
14254 @item C-c C-f
14255 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14256 @code{finish} command.
14257
14258 @item C-c C-r
14259 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14260 command.
14261
14262 @item C-c <
14263 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14264 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14265 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
14266
14267 @item C-c >
14268 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14269 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
14270 @end table
14271
14272 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
14273 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
14274
14275 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
14276 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
14277 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
14278 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
14279 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
14280 current one.
14281
14282 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14283 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14284 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14285 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14286 frame.
14287
14288 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14289 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14290 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14291 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14292 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14293 to correspond properly with the code.
14294
14295 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
14296 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
14297 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
14298
14299 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14300 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14301 @ignore
14302 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14303 @kindex Epoch
14304 @kindex inspect
14305
14306 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14307 called the @code{epoch}
14308 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14309 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14310 each value is printed in its own window.
14311 @end ignore
14312
14313
14314 @node GDB/MI
14315 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14316
14317 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14318
14319 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14320 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14321 specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14322 the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14323
14324 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14325 in the form of a reference manual.
14326
14327 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14328 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14329
14330 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14331
14332 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14333 This chapter uses the following notation:
14334
14335 @itemize @bullet
14336 @item
14337 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
14338
14339 @item
14340 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14341 it may or may not be given.
14342
14343 @item
14344 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14345 may repeat zero or more times.
14346
14347 @item
14348 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14349 may repeat one or more times.
14350
14351 @item
14352 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14353 @end itemize
14354
14355 @ignore
14356 @heading Dependencies
14357 @end ignore
14358
14359 @heading Acknowledgments
14360
14361 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14362 Elena Zannoni.
14363
14364 @menu
14365 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14366 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14367 * GDB/MI Output Records::
14368 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14369 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14370 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14371 * GDB/MI Program Control::
14372 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14373 @ignore
14374 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14375 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14376 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14377 @end ignore
14378 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14379 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14380 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14381 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14382 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14383 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14384 @end menu
14385
14386 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14387 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14388 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14389
14390 @menu
14391 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14392 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14393 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14394 @end menu
14395
14396 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14397 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14398
14399 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14400 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14401 @table @code
14402 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
14403 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14404
14405 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14406 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14407 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14408
14409 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14410 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14411 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14412
14413 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14414 "any sequence of digits"
14415
14416 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
14417 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14418
14419 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14420 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14421
14422 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14423 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14424
14425 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14426 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14427 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14428
14429 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14430 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14431
14432 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14433 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14434 @end table
14435
14436 @noindent
14437 Notes:
14438
14439 @itemize @bullet
14440 @item
14441 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14442 output is described below.
14443
14444 @item
14445 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14446 finishes.
14447
14448 @item
14449 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14450 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14451 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14452 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14453 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14454 @end itemize
14455
14456 Pragmatics:
14457
14458 @itemize @bullet
14459 @item
14460 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14461
14462 @item
14463 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14464 @end itemize
14465
14466 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14467 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14468
14469 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14470 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14471 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14472 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14473 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14474 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14475
14476 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14477 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14478 @var{token}.
14479
14480 @table @code
14481 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
14482 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14483
14484 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14485 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14486
14487 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14488 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14489
14490 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14491 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14492
14493 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14494 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14495
14496 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14497 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14498
14499 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14500 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14501
14502 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14503 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14504
14505 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14506 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14507
14508 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14509 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14510 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14511
14512 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
14513 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14514
14515 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14516 @code{ @var{string} }
14517
14518 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
14519 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14520
14521 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
14522 @code{@var{c-string}}
14523
14524 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14525 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14526
14527 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
14528 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14529 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14530
14531 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14532 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14533
14534 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14535 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14536
14537 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14538 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14539
14540 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14541 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14542
14543 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14544 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14545
14546 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14547 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
14548 @end table
14549
14550 @noindent
14551 Notes:
14552
14553 @itemize @bullet
14554 @item
14555 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14556
14557 @item
14558 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14559 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14560 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14561 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14562
14563 @item
14564 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14565 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14566 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14567 prefixed by @samp{+}.
14568
14569 @item
14570 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14571 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14572 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14573 @samp{*}.
14574
14575 @item
14576 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14577 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14578 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14579 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14580
14581 @item
14582 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14583 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14584 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14585 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14586
14587 @item
14588 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14589 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14590 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14591
14592 @item
14593 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14594 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14595 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14596 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14597
14598 @item
14599 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14600 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14601 @var{values}.
14602
14603
14604 @end itemize
14605
14606 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14607 details about the various output records.
14608
14609 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14610 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14611 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14612
14613 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14614 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14615 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14616 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14617
14618 @subsubheading Target Stop
14619 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14620 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14621
14622 @smallexample
14623 -> -stop
14624 <- (@value{GDBP})
14625 @end smallexample
14626
14627 @noindent
14628 and later:
14629
14630 @smallexample
14631 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14632 <- (@value{GDBP})
14633 @end smallexample
14634
14635 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14636
14637 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14638 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14639
14640 @smallexample
14641 -> print 1+2
14642 <- &"print 1+2\n"
14643 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14644 <- ^done
14645 <- (@value{GDBP})
14646 @end smallexample
14647
14648 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14649
14650 @smallexample
14651 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14652 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14653 <- (@value{GDBP})
14654 @end smallexample
14655
14656 @subsubheading A Bad Command
14657
14658 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14659
14660 @smallexample
14661 -> -rubbish
14662 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14663 <- (@value{GDBP})
14664 @end smallexample
14665
14666 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14667 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14668 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14669
14670 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14671 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14672 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14673 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14674 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14675 respond.
14676
14677 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14678 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14679 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14680 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14681 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14682
14683 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14684 @node GDB/MI Output Records
14685 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14686
14687 @menu
14688 * GDB/MI Result Records::
14689 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
14690 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14691 @end menu
14692
14693 @node GDB/MI Result Records
14694 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14695
14696 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14697 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14698 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14699 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14700
14701 @table @code
14702 @findex ^done
14703 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14704 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14705 values.
14706
14707 @item "^running"
14708 @findex ^running
14709 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14710 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14711 running.
14712
14713 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14714 @findex ^error
14715 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14716 error message.
14717 @end table
14718
14719 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
14720 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14721
14722 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14723 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14724 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14725 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14726 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14727
14728 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14729 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14730 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14731 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14732 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14733
14734 @table @code
14735 @item "~" @var{string-output}
14736 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14737 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14738
14739 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
14740 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14741 target.
14742
14743 @item "&" @var{string-output}
14744 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14745 internals.
14746 @end table
14747
14748 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14749 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14750
14751 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14752 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14753 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14754 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14755 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14756 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14757
14758 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14759
14760 @table @code
14761 @item "*" "stop"
14762 @end table
14763
14764
14765 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14766 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14767 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14768
14769 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14770 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14771
14772 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14773 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14774 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14775 not yet implemented.
14776
14777 @subheading Motivation
14778
14779 The motivation for this collection of commands.
14780
14781 @subheading Introduction
14782
14783 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14784
14785 @subheading Commands
14786
14787 For each command in the block, the following is described:
14788
14789 @subsubheading Synopsis
14790
14791 @smallexample
14792 -command @var{args}@dots{}
14793 @end smallexample
14794
14795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14796
14797 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14798
14799 @subsubheading Result
14800
14801 @subsubheading Out-of-band
14802
14803 @subsubheading Notes
14804
14805 @subsubheading Example
14806
14807
14808 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14809 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
14810 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
14811
14812 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
14813 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
14814 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
14815 breakpoints.
14816
14817 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
14818 @findex -break-after
14819
14820 @subsubheading Synopsis
14821
14822 @smallexample
14823 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
14824 @end smallexample
14825
14826 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
14827 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
14828 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
14829 @samp{-break-list} command below.
14830
14831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14832
14833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
14834
14835 @subsubheading Example
14836
14837 @smallexample
14838 (@value{GDBP})
14839 -break-insert main
14840 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
14841 (@value{GDBP})
14842 -break-after 1 3
14843 ~
14844 ^done
14845 (@value{GDBP})
14846 -break-list
14847 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14848 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14849 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14850 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14851 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14852 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14853 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14854 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14855 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
14856 ignore="3"@}]@}
14857 (@value{GDBP})
14858 @end smallexample
14859
14860 @ignore
14861 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
14862 @findex -break-catch
14863
14864 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
14865 @findex -break-commands
14866 @end ignore
14867
14868
14869 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
14870 @findex -break-condition
14871
14872 @subsubheading Synopsis
14873
14874 @smallexample
14875 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
14876 @end smallexample
14877
14878 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
14879 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
14880 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
14881 command below).
14882
14883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14884
14885 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
14886
14887 @subsubheading Example
14888
14889 @smallexample
14890 (@value{GDBP})
14891 -break-condition 1 1
14892 ^done
14893 (@value{GDBP})
14894 -break-list
14895 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14896 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14897 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14898 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14899 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14900 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14901 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14902 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14903 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
14904 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
14905 (@value{GDBP})
14906 @end smallexample
14907
14908 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
14909 @findex -break-delete
14910
14911 @subsubheading Synopsis
14912
14913 @smallexample
14914 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14915 @end smallexample
14916
14917 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
14918 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
14919
14920 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14921
14922 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
14923
14924 @subsubheading Example
14925
14926 @smallexample
14927 (@value{GDBP})
14928 -break-delete 1
14929 ^done
14930 (@value{GDBP})
14931 -break-list
14932 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14933 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14934 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14935 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14936 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14937 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14938 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14939 body=[]@}
14940 (@value{GDBP})
14941 @end smallexample
14942
14943 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
14944 @findex -break-disable
14945
14946 @subsubheading Synopsis
14947
14948 @smallexample
14949 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14950 @end smallexample
14951
14952 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
14953 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
14954
14955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14956
14957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
14958
14959 @subsubheading Example
14960
14961 @smallexample
14962 (@value{GDBP})
14963 -break-disable 2
14964 ^done
14965 (@value{GDBP})
14966 -break-list
14967 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14968 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14969 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14970 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14971 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14972 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14973 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14974 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
14975 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14976 (@value{GDBP})
14977 @end smallexample
14978
14979 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
14980 @findex -break-enable
14981
14982 @subsubheading Synopsis
14983
14984 @smallexample
14985 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14986 @end smallexample
14987
14988 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
14989
14990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14991
14992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
14993
14994 @subsubheading Example
14995
14996 @smallexample
14997 (@value{GDBP})
14998 -break-enable 2
14999 ^done
15000 (@value{GDBP})
15001 -break-list
15002 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15003 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15004 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15005 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15006 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15007 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15008 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15009 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15010 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
15011 (@value{GDBP})
15012 @end smallexample
15013
15014 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
15015 @findex -break-info
15016
15017 @subsubheading Synopsis
15018
15019 @smallexample
15020 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
15021 @end smallexample
15022
15023 @c REDUNDANT???
15024 Get information about a single breakpoint.
15025
15026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15027
15028 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
15029
15030 @subsubheading Example
15031 N.A.
15032
15033 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
15034 @findex -break-insert
15035
15036 @subsubheading Synopsis
15037
15038 @smallexample
15039 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
15040 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
15041 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
15042 @end smallexample
15043
15044 @noindent
15045 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
15046
15047 @itemize @bullet
15048 @item function
15049 @c @item +offset
15050 @c @item -offset
15051 @c @item linenum
15052 @item filename:linenum
15053 @item filename:function
15054 @item *address
15055 @end itemize
15056
15057 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
15058
15059 @table @samp
15060 @item -t
15061 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
15062 @item -h
15063 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
15064 @item -c @var{condition}
15065 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
15066 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
15067 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
15068 @item -r
15069 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
15070 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
15071 expresson.
15072 @end table
15073
15074 @subsubheading Result
15075
15076 The result is in the form:
15077
15078 @smallexample
15079 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
15080 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
15081 @end smallexample
15082
15083 @noindent
15084 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
15085 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
15086 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
15087 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
15088
15089 Note: this format is open to change.
15090 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
15091
15092 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15093
15094 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
15095 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
15096
15097 @subsubheading Example
15098
15099 @smallexample
15100 (@value{GDBP})
15101 -break-insert main
15102 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
15103 (@value{GDBP})
15104 -break-insert -t foo
15105 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15106 (@value{GDBP})
15107 -break-list
15108 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15109 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15110 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15111 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15112 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15113 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15114 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15115 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15116 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
15117 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
15118 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
15119 (@value{GDBP})
15120 -break-insert -r foo.*
15121 ~int foo(int, int);
15122 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15123 (@value{GDBP})
15124 @end smallexample
15125
15126 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
15127 @findex -break-list
15128
15129 @subsubheading Synopsis
15130
15131 @smallexample
15132 -break-list
15133 @end smallexample
15134
15135 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
15136
15137 @table @samp
15138 @item Number
15139 number of the breakpoint
15140 @item Type
15141 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
15142 @item Disposition
15143 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
15144 or @samp{nokeep}
15145 @item Enabled
15146 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
15147 @item Address
15148 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
15149 @item What
15150 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
15151 name, line number
15152 @item Times
15153 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
15154 @end table
15155
15156 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
15157 @code{body} field is an empty list.
15158
15159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15160
15161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
15162
15163 @subsubheading Example
15164
15165 @smallexample
15166 (@value{GDBP})
15167 -break-list
15168 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15169 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15170 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15171 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15172 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15173 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15174 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15175 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15176 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
15177 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15178 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
15179 (@value{GDBP})
15180 @end smallexample
15181
15182 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
15183
15184 @smallexample
15185 (@value{GDBP})
15186 -break-list
15187 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
15188 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15189 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15190 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15191 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15192 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15193 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15194 body=[]@}
15195 (@value{GDBP})
15196 @end smallexample
15197
15198 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
15199 @findex -break-watch
15200
15201 @subsubheading Synopsis
15202
15203 @smallexample
15204 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
15205 @end smallexample
15206
15207 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
15208 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
15209 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
15210 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
15211 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
15212 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
15213 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
15214 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
15215
15216 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
15217 breakpoints inserted.
15218
15219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15220
15221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
15222 @samp{rwatch}.
15223
15224 @subsubheading Example
15225
15226 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
15227
15228 @smallexample
15229 (@value{GDBP})
15230 -break-watch x
15231 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
15232 (@value{GDBP})
15233 -exec-continue
15234 ^running
15235 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
15236 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
15237 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
15238 (@value{GDBP})
15239 @end smallexample
15240
15241 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
15242 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
15243 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
15244
15245 @smallexample
15246 (@value{GDBP})
15247 -break-watch C
15248 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
15249 (@value{GDBP})
15250 -exec-continue
15251 ^running
15252 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
15253 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15254 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15255 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15256 (@value{GDBP})
15257 -exec-continue
15258 ^running
15259 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
15260 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15261 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15262 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15263 (@value{GDBP})
15264 @end smallexample
15265
15266 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15267 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15268 deleted.
15269
15270 @smallexample
15271 (@value{GDBP})
15272 -break-watch C
15273 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15274 (@value{GDBP})
15275 -break-list
15276 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15277 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15278 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15279 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15280 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15281 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15282 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15283 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15284 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15285 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15286 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15287 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15288 (@value{GDBP})
15289 -exec-continue
15290 ^running
15291 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15292 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15293 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15294 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15295 (@value{GDBP})
15296 -break-list
15297 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15298 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15299 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15300 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15301 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15302 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15303 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15304 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15305 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15306 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15307 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15308 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15309 (@value{GDBP})
15310 -exec-continue
15311 ^running
15312 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15313 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15314 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15315 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15316 (@value{GDBP})
15317 -break-list
15318 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15319 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15320 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15321 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15322 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15323 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15324 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15325 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15326 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15327 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15328 (@value{GDBP})
15329 @end smallexample
15330
15331 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15332 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15333 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15334
15335 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15336 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15337 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15338 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15339
15340 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15341 @c @subheading -data-assign
15342 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15343 @c @subsubheading GDB command
15344 @c set variable
15345 @c @subsubheading Example
15346 @c N.A.
15347
15348 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15349 @findex -data-disassemble
15350
15351 @subsubheading Synopsis
15352
15353 @smallexample
15354 -data-disassemble
15355 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15356 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15357 -- @var{mode}
15358 @end smallexample
15359
15360 @noindent
15361 Where:
15362
15363 @table @samp
15364 @item @var{start-addr}
15365 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15366 @item @var{end-addr}
15367 is the end address
15368 @item @var{filename}
15369 is the name of the file to disassemble
15370 @item @var{linenum}
15371 is the line number to disassemble around
15372 @item @var{lines}
15373 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15374 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15375 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15376 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15377 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15378 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15379 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15380 are displayed.
15381 @item @var{mode}
15382 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15383 disassembly).
15384 @end table
15385
15386 @subsubheading Result
15387
15388 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15389
15390 @itemize @bullet
15391 @item Address
15392 @item Func-name
15393 @item Offset
15394 @item Instruction
15395 @end itemize
15396
15397 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15398 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15399
15400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15401
15402 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15403
15404 @subsubheading Example
15405
15406 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15407
15408 @smallexample
15409 (@value{GDBP})
15410 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15411 ^done,
15412 asm_insns=[
15413 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15414 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15415 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15416 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15417 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15418 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15419 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15420 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15421 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15422 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15423 (@value{GDBP})
15424 @end smallexample
15425
15426 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15427 @code{main}.
15428
15429 @smallexample
15430 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15431 ^done,asm_insns=[
15432 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15433 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15434 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15435 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15436 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15437 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15438 [@dots{}]
15439 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15440 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15441 (@value{GDBP})
15442 @end smallexample
15443
15444 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15445
15446 @smallexample
15447 (@value{GDBP})
15448 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15449 ^done,asm_insns=[
15450 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15451 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15452 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15453 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15454 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15455 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15456 (@value{GDBP})
15457 @end smallexample
15458
15459 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15460
15461 @smallexample
15462 (@value{GDBP})
15463 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15464 ^done,asm_insns=[
15465 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15466 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15467 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15468 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15469 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15470 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15471 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15472 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15473 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15474 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15475 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15476 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15477 (@value{GDBP})
15478 @end smallexample
15479
15480
15481 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15482 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
15483
15484 @subsubheading Synopsis
15485
15486 @smallexample
15487 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15488 @end smallexample
15489
15490 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15491 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15492 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15493
15494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15495
15496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15497 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15498 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
15499
15500 @subsubheading Example
15501
15502 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15503 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15504 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15505 output.
15506
15507 @smallexample
15508 211-data-evaluate-expression A
15509 211^done,value="1"
15510 (@value{GDBP})
15511 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15512 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15513 (@value{GDBP})
15514 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15515 411^done,value="4"
15516 (@value{GDBP})
15517 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15518 511^done,value="4"
15519 (@value{GDBP})
15520 @end smallexample
15521
15522
15523 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15524 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
15525
15526 @subsubheading Synopsis
15527
15528 @smallexample
15529 -data-list-changed-registers
15530 @end smallexample
15531
15532 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15533
15534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15535
15536 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15537 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15538
15539 @subsubheading Example
15540
15541 On a PPC MBX board:
15542
15543 @smallexample
15544 (@value{GDBP})
15545 -exec-continue
15546 ^running
15547
15548 (@value{GDBP})
15549 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15550 args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15551 (@value{GDBP})
15552 -data-list-changed-registers
15553 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15554 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15555 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15556 (@value{GDBP})
15557 @end smallexample
15558
15559
15560 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15561 @findex -data-list-register-names
15562
15563 @subsubheading Synopsis
15564
15565 @smallexample
15566 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15567 @end smallexample
15568
15569 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15570 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15571 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15572 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15573 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15574 include empty register names.
15575
15576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15577
15578 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15579 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15580 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15581
15582 @subsubheading Example
15583
15584 For the PPC MBX board:
15585 @smallexample
15586 (@value{GDBP})
15587 -data-list-register-names
15588 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15589 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15590 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15591 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15592 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15593 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15594 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15595 (@value{GDBP})
15596 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15597 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15598 (@value{GDBP})
15599 @end smallexample
15600
15601 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15602 @findex -data-list-register-values
15603
15604 @subsubheading Synopsis
15605
15606 @smallexample
15607 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15608 @end smallexample
15609
15610 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15611 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15612 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15613 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15614
15615 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15616
15617 @table @code
15618 @item x
15619 Hexadecimal
15620 @item o
15621 Octal
15622 @item t
15623 Binary
15624 @item d
15625 Decimal
15626 @item r
15627 Raw
15628 @item N
15629 Natural
15630 @end table
15631
15632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15633
15634 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15635 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15636
15637 @subsubheading Example
15638
15639 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15640 don't appear in the actual output):
15641
15642 @smallexample
15643 (@value{GDBP})
15644 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
15645 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15646 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15647 (@value{GDBP})
15648 -data-list-register-values x
15649 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15650 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15651 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15652 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15653 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15654 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15655 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15656 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15657 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15658 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15659 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15660 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15661 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15662 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15663 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15664 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15665 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15666 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15667 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15668 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15669 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15670 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15671 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15672 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15673 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15674 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15675 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15676 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15677 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15678 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15679 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15680 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15681 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15682 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15683 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15684 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15685 (@value{GDBP})
15686 @end smallexample
15687
15688
15689 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15690 @findex -data-read-memory
15691
15692 @subsubheading Synopsis
15693
15694 @smallexample
15695 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15696 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15697 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15698 @end smallexample
15699
15700 @noindent
15701 where:
15702
15703 @table @samp
15704 @item @var{address}
15705 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15706 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15707 quoted using the C convention.
15708
15709 @item @var{word-format}
15710 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15711 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15712 ,Output formats}).
15713
15714 @item @var{word-size}
15715 The size of each memory word in bytes.
15716
15717 @item @var{nr-rows}
15718 The number of rows in the output table.
15719
15720 @item @var{nr-cols}
15721 The number of columns in the output table.
15722
15723 @item @var{aschar}
15724 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15725 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15726 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15727 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15728
15729 @item @var{byte-offset}
15730 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15731 @end table
15732
15733 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15734 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15735 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15736 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15737 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15738 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15739 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15740 @samp{addr}.
15741
15742 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15743 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15744 @samp{prev-page}.
15745
15746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15747
15748 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15749 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15750
15751 @subsubheading Example
15752
15753 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15754 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15755 word. Display each word in hex.
15756
15757 @smallexample
15758 (@value{GDBP})
15759 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
15760 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15761 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15762 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15763 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15764 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15765 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15766 (@value{GDBP})
15767 @end smallexample
15768
15769 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15770 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15771
15772 @smallexample
15773 (@value{GDBP})
15774 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
15775 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15776 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15777 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15778 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15779 (@value{GDBP})
15780 @end smallexample
15781
15782 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15783 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15784 used as the non-printable character.
15785
15786 @smallexample
15787 (@value{GDBP})
15788 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
15789 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15790 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
15791 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
15792 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15793 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15794 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15795 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15796 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
15797 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
15798 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
15799 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
15800 (@value{GDBP})
15801 @end smallexample
15802
15803 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
15804 @findex -display-delete
15805
15806 @subsubheading Synopsis
15807
15808 @smallexample
15809 -display-delete @var{number}
15810 @end smallexample
15811
15812 Delete the display @var{number}.
15813
15814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15815
15816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
15817
15818 @subsubheading Example
15819 N.A.
15820
15821
15822 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
15823 @findex -display-disable
15824
15825 @subsubheading Synopsis
15826
15827 @smallexample
15828 -display-disable @var{number}
15829 @end smallexample
15830
15831 Disable display @var{number}.
15832
15833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15834
15835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
15836
15837 @subsubheading Example
15838 N.A.
15839
15840
15841 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
15842 @findex -display-enable
15843
15844 @subsubheading Synopsis
15845
15846 @smallexample
15847 -display-enable @var{number}
15848 @end smallexample
15849
15850 Enable display @var{number}.
15851
15852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15853
15854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
15855
15856 @subsubheading Example
15857 N.A.
15858
15859
15860 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
15861 @findex -display-insert
15862
15863 @subsubheading Synopsis
15864
15865 @smallexample
15866 -display-insert @var{expression}
15867 @end smallexample
15868
15869 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
15870
15871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15872
15873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
15874
15875 @subsubheading Example
15876 N.A.
15877
15878
15879 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
15880 @findex -display-list
15881
15882 @subsubheading Synopsis
15883
15884 @smallexample
15885 -display-list
15886 @end smallexample
15887
15888 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
15889
15890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15891
15892 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
15893
15894 @subsubheading Example
15895 N.A.
15896
15897
15898 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
15899 @findex -environment-cd
15900
15901 @subsubheading Synopsis
15902
15903 @smallexample
15904 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
15905 @end smallexample
15906
15907 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
15908
15909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15910
15911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
15912
15913 @subsubheading Example
15914
15915 @smallexample
15916 (@value{GDBP})
15917 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15918 ^done
15919 (@value{GDBP})
15920 @end smallexample
15921
15922
15923 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
15924 @findex -environment-directory
15925
15926 @subsubheading Synopsis
15927
15928 @smallexample
15929 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15930 @end smallexample
15931
15932 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
15933 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
15934 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
15935 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15936 occurs as normal.
15937 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15938 multiple directories in a single command
15939 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15940 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15941 If blanks are needed as
15942 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15943 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15944 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15945 character must not be used
15946 in any directory name.
15947 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
15948
15949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15950
15951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
15952
15953 @subsubheading Example
15954
15955 @smallexample
15956 (@value{GDBP})
15957 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15958 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15959 (@value{GDBP})
15960 -environment-directory ""
15961 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15962 (@value{GDBP})
15963 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
15964 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
15965 (@value{GDBP})
15966 -environment-directory -r
15967 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
15968 (@value{GDBP})
15969 @end smallexample
15970
15971
15972 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
15973 @findex -environment-path
15974
15975 @subsubheading Synopsis
15976
15977 @smallexample
15978 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15979 @end smallexample
15980
15981 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
15982 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
15983 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
15984 supplied in addition to the
15985 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15986 occurs as normal.
15987 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15988 multiple directories in a single command
15989 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15990 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15991 If blanks are needed as
15992 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15993 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15994 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15995 character must not be used
15996 in any directory name.
15997 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
15998
15999
16000 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16001
16002 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
16003
16004 @subsubheading Example
16005
16006 @smallexample
16007 (@value{GDBP})
16008 -environment-path
16009 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
16010 (@value{GDBP})
16011 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
16012 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
16013 (@value{GDBP})
16014 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
16015 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
16016 (@value{GDBP})
16017 @end smallexample
16018
16019
16020 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
16021 @findex -environment-pwd
16022
16023 @subsubheading Synopsis
16024
16025 @smallexample
16026 -environment-pwd
16027 @end smallexample
16028
16029 Show the current working directory.
16030
16031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16032
16033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
16034
16035 @subsubheading Example
16036
16037 @smallexample
16038 (@value{GDBP})
16039 -environment-pwd
16040 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
16041 (@value{GDBP})
16042 @end smallexample
16043
16044 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16045 @node GDB/MI Program Control
16046 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
16047
16048 @subsubheading Program termination
16049
16050 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
16051 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
16052 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
16053
16054 @subsubheading Examples
16055
16056 @noindent
16057 Program exited normally:
16058
16059 @smallexample
16060 (@value{GDBP})
16061 -exec-run
16062 ^running
16063 (@value{GDBP})
16064 x = 55
16065 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
16066 (@value{GDBP})
16067 @end smallexample
16068
16069 @noindent
16070 Program exited exceptionally:
16071
16072 @smallexample
16073 (@value{GDBP})
16074 -exec-run
16075 ^running
16076 (@value{GDBP})
16077 x = 55
16078 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
16079 (@value{GDBP})
16080 @end smallexample
16081
16082 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
16083 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
16084
16085 @smallexample
16086 (@value{GDBP})
16087 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
16088 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
16089 @end smallexample
16090
16091
16092 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
16093 @findex -exec-abort
16094
16095 @subsubheading Synopsis
16096
16097 @smallexample
16098 -exec-abort
16099 @end smallexample
16100
16101 Kill the inferior running program.
16102
16103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16104
16105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
16106
16107 @subsubheading Example
16108 N.A.
16109
16110
16111 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
16112 @findex -exec-arguments
16113
16114 @subsubheading Synopsis
16115
16116 @smallexample
16117 -exec-arguments @var{args}
16118 @end smallexample
16119
16120 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
16121 @samp{-exec-run}.
16122
16123 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16124
16125 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
16126
16127 @subsubheading Example
16128
16129 @c FIXME!
16130 Don't have one around.
16131
16132
16133 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
16134 @findex -exec-continue
16135
16136 @subsubheading Synopsis
16137
16138 @smallexample
16139 -exec-continue
16140 @end smallexample
16141
16142 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16143 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
16144
16145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16146
16147 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
16148
16149 @subsubheading Example
16150
16151 @smallexample
16152 -exec-continue
16153 ^running
16154 (@value{GDBP})
16155 @@Hello world
16156 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
16157 file="hello.c",line="13"@}
16158 (@value{GDBP})
16159 @end smallexample
16160
16161
16162 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
16163 @findex -exec-finish
16164
16165 @subsubheading Synopsis
16166
16167 @smallexample
16168 -exec-finish
16169 @end smallexample
16170
16171 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16172 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
16173 the function.
16174
16175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16176
16177 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
16178
16179 @subsubheading Example
16180
16181 Function returning @code{void}.
16182
16183 @smallexample
16184 -exec-finish
16185 ^running
16186 (@value{GDBP})
16187 @@hello from foo
16188 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16189 file="hello.c",line="7"@}
16190 (@value{GDBP})
16191 @end smallexample
16192
16193 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
16194 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
16195 value itself.
16196
16197 @smallexample
16198 -exec-finish
16199 ^running
16200 (@value{GDBP})
16201 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
16202 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
16203 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16204 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
16205 (@value{GDBP})
16206 @end smallexample
16207
16208
16209 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
16210 @findex -exec-interrupt
16211
16212 @subsubheading Synopsis
16213
16214 @smallexample
16215 -exec-interrupt
16216 @end smallexample
16217
16218 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
16219 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
16220 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
16221 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
16222 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
16223
16224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16225
16226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
16227
16228 @subsubheading Example
16229
16230 @smallexample
16231 (@value{GDBP})
16232 111-exec-continue
16233 111^running
16234
16235 (@value{GDBP})
16236 222-exec-interrupt
16237 222^done
16238 (@value{GDBP})
16239 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
16240 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
16241 (@value{GDBP})
16242
16243 (@value{GDBP})
16244 -exec-interrupt
16245 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
16246 (@value{GDBP})
16247 @end smallexample
16248
16249
16250 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
16251 @findex -exec-next
16252
16253 @subsubheading Synopsis
16254
16255 @smallexample
16256 -exec-next
16257 @end smallexample
16258
16259 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16260 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
16261
16262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16263
16264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16265
16266 @subsubheading Example
16267
16268 @smallexample
16269 -exec-next
16270 ^running
16271 (@value{GDBP})
16272 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16273 (@value{GDBP})
16274 @end smallexample
16275
16276
16277 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16278 @findex -exec-next-instruction
16279
16280 @subsubheading Synopsis
16281
16282 @smallexample
16283 -exec-next-instruction
16284 @end smallexample
16285
16286 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16287 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16288 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16289 address will be printed as well.
16290
16291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16292
16293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16294
16295 @subsubheading Example
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 (@value{GDBP})
16299 -exec-next-instruction
16300 ^running
16301
16302 (@value{GDBP})
16303 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16304 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16305 (@value{GDBP})
16306 @end smallexample
16307
16308
16309 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16310 @findex -exec-return
16311
16312 @subsubheading Synopsis
16313
16314 @smallexample
16315 -exec-return
16316 @end smallexample
16317
16318 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16319 Displays the new current frame.
16320
16321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16322
16323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16324
16325 @subsubheading Example
16326
16327 @smallexample
16328 (@value{GDBP})
16329 200-break-insert callee4
16330 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16331 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16332 (@value{GDBP})
16333 000-exec-run
16334 000^running
16335 (@value{GDBP})
16336 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16337 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16338 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16339 (@value{GDBP})
16340 205-break-delete
16341 205^done
16342 (@value{GDBP})
16343 111-exec-return
16344 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16345 args=[@{name="strarg",
16346 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16347 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16348 (@value{GDBP})
16349 @end smallexample
16350
16351
16352 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16353 @findex -exec-run
16354
16355 @subsubheading Synopsis
16356
16357 @smallexample
16358 -exec-run
16359 @end smallexample
16360
16361 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16362 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16363 encountered or the program exits.
16364
16365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16366
16367 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16368
16369 @subsubheading Example
16370
16371 @smallexample
16372 (@value{GDBP})
16373 -break-insert main
16374 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16375 (@value{GDBP})
16376 -exec-run
16377 ^running
16378 (@value{GDBP})
16379 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16380 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16381 (@value{GDBP})
16382 @end smallexample
16383
16384
16385 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16386 @findex -exec-show-arguments
16387
16388 @subsubheading Synopsis
16389
16390 @smallexample
16391 -exec-show-arguments
16392 @end smallexample
16393
16394 Print the arguments of the program.
16395
16396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16397
16398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16399
16400 @subsubheading Example
16401 N.A.
16402
16403 @c @subheading -exec-signal
16404
16405 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16406 @findex -exec-step
16407
16408 @subsubheading Synopsis
16409
16410 @smallexample
16411 -exec-step
16412 @end smallexample
16413
16414 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16415 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16416 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16417 instruction of the called function.
16418
16419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16420
16421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16422
16423 @subsubheading Example
16424
16425 Stepping into a function:
16426
16427 @smallexample
16428 -exec-step
16429 ^running
16430 (@value{GDBP})
16431 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16432 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16433 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16434 (@value{GDBP})
16435 @end smallexample
16436
16437 Regular stepping:
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 -exec-step
16441 ^running
16442 (@value{GDBP})
16443 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16444 (@value{GDBP})
16445 @end smallexample
16446
16447
16448 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16449 @findex -exec-step-instruction
16450
16451 @subsubheading Synopsis
16452
16453 @smallexample
16454 -exec-step-instruction
16455 @end smallexample
16456
16457 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16458 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16459 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16460 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16461 well.
16462
16463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16464
16465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16466
16467 @subsubheading Example
16468
16469 @smallexample
16470 (@value{GDBP})
16471 -exec-step-instruction
16472 ^running
16473
16474 (@value{GDBP})
16475 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16476 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16477 (@value{GDBP})
16478 -exec-step-instruction
16479 ^running
16480
16481 (@value{GDBP})
16482 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16483 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16484 (@value{GDBP})
16485 @end smallexample
16486
16487
16488 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16489 @findex -exec-until
16490
16491 @subsubheading Synopsis
16492
16493 @smallexample
16494 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16495 @end smallexample
16496
16497 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16498 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16499 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16500 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16501
16502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16503
16504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16505
16506 @subsubheading Example
16507
16508 @smallexample
16509 (@value{GDBP})
16510 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
16511 ^running
16512 (@value{GDBP})
16513 x = 55
16514 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16515 file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16516 (@value{GDBP})
16517 @end smallexample
16518
16519 @ignore
16520 @subheading -file-clear
16521 Is this going away????
16522 @end ignore
16523
16524
16525 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16526 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16527
16528 @subsubheading Synopsis
16529
16530 @smallexample
16531 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16532 @end smallexample
16533
16534 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16535 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16536 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16537 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16538 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16539 notification.
16540
16541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16542
16543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16544
16545 @subsubheading Example
16546
16547 @smallexample
16548 (@value{GDBP})
16549 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16550 ^done
16551 (@value{GDBP})
16552 @end smallexample
16553
16554
16555 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16556 @findex -file-exec-file
16557
16558 @subsubheading Synopsis
16559
16560 @smallexample
16561 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16562 @end smallexample
16563
16564 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16565 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16566 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16567 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16568 notification.
16569
16570 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16571
16572 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16573
16574 @subsubheading Example
16575
16576 @smallexample
16577 (@value{GDBP})
16578 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16579 ^done
16580 (@value{GDBP})
16581 @end smallexample
16582
16583
16584 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16585 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
16586
16587 @subsubheading Synopsis
16588
16589 @smallexample
16590 -file-list-exec-sections
16591 @end smallexample
16592
16593 List the sections of the current executable file.
16594
16595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16596
16597 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16598 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16599 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
16600
16601 @subsubheading Example
16602 N.A.
16603
16604
16605 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
16606 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
16607
16608 @subsubheading Synopsis
16609
16610 @smallexample
16611 -file-list-exec-source-file
16612 @end smallexample
16613
16614 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
16615 to the current source file for the current executable.
16616
16617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16618
16619 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16620
16621 @subsubheading Example
16622
16623 @smallexample
16624 (@value{GDBP})
16625 123-file-list-exec-source-file
16626 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
16627 (@value{GDBP})
16628 @end smallexample
16629
16630
16631 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16632 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16633
16634 @subsubheading Synopsis
16635
16636 @smallexample
16637 -file-list-exec-source-files
16638 @end smallexample
16639
16640 List the source files for the current executable.
16641
16642 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16643
16644 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16645 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16646
16647 @subsubheading Example
16648 N.A.
16649
16650
16651 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16652 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16653
16654 @subsubheading Synopsis
16655
16656 @smallexample
16657 -file-list-shared-libraries
16658 @end smallexample
16659
16660 List the shared libraries in the program.
16661
16662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16663
16664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16665
16666 @subsubheading Example
16667 N.A.
16668
16669
16670 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16671 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
16672
16673 @subsubheading Synopsis
16674
16675 @smallexample
16676 -file-list-symbol-files
16677 @end smallexample
16678
16679 List symbol files.
16680
16681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16682
16683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16684
16685 @subsubheading Example
16686 N.A.
16687
16688
16689 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16690 @findex -file-symbol-file
16691
16692 @subsubheading Synopsis
16693
16694 @smallexample
16695 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16696 @end smallexample
16697
16698 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16699 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16700 produced, except for a completion notification.
16701
16702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16703
16704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16705
16706 @subsubheading Example
16707
16708 @smallexample
16709 (@value{GDBP})
16710 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16711 ^done
16712 (@value{GDBP})
16713 @end smallexample
16714
16715 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16716 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16717 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16718
16719 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
16720
16721 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16722 @findex -gdb-exit
16723
16724 @subsubheading Synopsis
16725
16726 @smallexample
16727 -gdb-exit
16728 @end smallexample
16729
16730 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16731
16732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16733
16734 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16735
16736 @subsubheading Example
16737
16738 @smallexample
16739 (@value{GDBP})
16740 -gdb-exit
16741 @end smallexample
16742
16743 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16744 @findex -gdb-set
16745
16746 @subsubheading Synopsis
16747
16748 @smallexample
16749 -gdb-set
16750 @end smallexample
16751
16752 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16753 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16754
16755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16756
16757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16758
16759 @subsubheading Example
16760
16761 @smallexample
16762 (@value{GDBP})
16763 -gdb-set $foo=3
16764 ^done
16765 (@value{GDBP})
16766 @end smallexample
16767
16768
16769 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16770 @findex -gdb-show
16771
16772 @subsubheading Synopsis
16773
16774 @smallexample
16775 -gdb-show
16776 @end smallexample
16777
16778 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16779
16780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16781
16782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
16783
16784 @subsubheading Example
16785
16786 @smallexample
16787 (@value{GDBP})
16788 -gdb-show annotate
16789 ^done,value="0"
16790 (@value{GDBP})
16791 @end smallexample
16792
16793 @c @subheading -gdb-source
16794
16795
16796 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
16797 @findex -gdb-version
16798
16799 @subsubheading Synopsis
16800
16801 @smallexample
16802 -gdb-version
16803 @end smallexample
16804
16805 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
16806
16807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16808
16809 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
16810 information when you start an interactive session.
16811
16812 @subsubheading Example
16813
16814 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
16815 @c box in TeX.
16816 @smallexample
16817 (@value{GDBP})
16818 -gdb-version
16819 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
16820 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16821 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
16822 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
16823 ~ certain conditions.
16824 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
16825 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
16826 ~ details.
16827 ~This GDB was configured as
16828 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
16829 ^done
16830 (@value{GDBP})
16831 @end smallexample
16832
16833 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
16834 @findex -interpreter-exec
16835
16836 @subheading Synopsis
16837
16838 @smallexample
16839 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
16840 @end smallexample
16841
16842 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
16843
16844 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
16845
16846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
16847
16848 @subheading Example
16849
16850 @smallexample
16851 (@value{GDBP})
16852 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
16853 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
16854 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
16855 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
16856 ^done
16857 (@value{GDBP})
16858 @end smallexample
16859
16860 @ignore
16861 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16862 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
16863 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
16864
16865 The Kod commands are not implemented.
16866
16867 @c @subheading -kod-info
16868
16869 @c @subheading -kod-list
16870
16871 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
16872
16873 @c @subheading -kod-show
16874
16875 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16876 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
16877 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
16878
16879 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
16880
16881 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
16882
16883 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
16884
16885 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
16886
16887 @c @subheading -overlay-map
16888
16889 @c @subheading -overlay-off
16890
16891 @c @subheading -overlay-on
16892
16893 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
16894
16895 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16896 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
16897 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
16898
16899 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
16900
16901 @c @subheading -signal-handle
16902
16903 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
16904
16905 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
16906 @end ignore
16907
16908
16909 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16910 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
16911 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
16912
16913
16914 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
16915 @findex -stack-info-frame
16916
16917 @subsubheading Synopsis
16918
16919 @smallexample
16920 -stack-info-frame
16921 @end smallexample
16922
16923 Get info on the current frame.
16924
16925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16926
16927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
16928 (without arguments).
16929
16930 @subsubheading Example
16931 N.A.
16932
16933 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
16934 @findex -stack-info-depth
16935
16936 @subsubheading Synopsis
16937
16938 @smallexample
16939 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
16940 @end smallexample
16941
16942 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
16943 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
16944
16945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16946
16947 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
16948
16949 @subsubheading Example
16950
16951 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
16952
16953 @smallexample
16954 (@value{GDBP})
16955 -stack-info-depth
16956 ^done,depth="12"
16957 (@value{GDBP})
16958 -stack-info-depth 4
16959 ^done,depth="4"
16960 (@value{GDBP})
16961 -stack-info-depth 12
16962 ^done,depth="12"
16963 (@value{GDBP})
16964 -stack-info-depth 11
16965 ^done,depth="11"
16966 (@value{GDBP})
16967 -stack-info-depth 13
16968 ^done,depth="12"
16969 (@value{GDBP})
16970 @end smallexample
16971
16972 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
16973 @findex -stack-list-arguments
16974
16975 @subsubheading Synopsis
16976
16977 @smallexample
16978 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
16979 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16980 @end smallexample
16981
16982 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
16983 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
16984 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
16985 stack.
16986
16987 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
16988 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
16989 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
16990
16991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16992
16993 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
16994 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
16995 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
16996
16997 @subsubheading Example
16998
16999 @smallexample
17000 (@value{GDBP})
17001 -stack-list-frames
17002 ^done,
17003 stack=[
17004 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17005 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
17006 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
17007 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
17008 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
17009 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
17010 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
17011 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
17012 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
17013 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
17014 (@value{GDBP})
17015 -stack-list-arguments 0
17016 ^done,
17017 stack-args=[
17018 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
17019 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
17020 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
17021 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
17022 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
17023 (@value{GDBP})
17024 -stack-list-arguments 1
17025 ^done,
17026 stack-args=[
17027 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
17028 frame=@{level="1",
17029 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
17030 frame=@{level="2",args=[
17031 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17032 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
17033 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
17034 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17035 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
17036 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
17037 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
17038 (@value{GDBP})
17039 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
17040 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
17041 (@value{GDBP})
17042 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
17043 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
17044 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17045 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
17046 (@value{GDBP})
17047 @end smallexample
17048
17049 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
17050
17051
17052 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
17053 @findex -stack-list-frames
17054
17055 @subsubheading Synopsis
17056
17057 @smallexample
17058 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
17059 @end smallexample
17060
17061 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
17062 following info:
17063
17064 @table @samp
17065 @item @var{level}
17066 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
17067 @item @var{addr}
17068 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
17069 @item @var{func}
17070 Function name.
17071 @item @var{file}
17072 File name of the source file where the function lives.
17073 @item @var{line}
17074 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
17075 @end table
17076
17077 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
17078 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
17079 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
17080 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
17081
17082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17083
17084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
17085
17086 @subsubheading Example
17087
17088 Full stack backtrace:
17089
17090 @smallexample
17091 (@value{GDBP})
17092 -stack-list-frames
17093 ^done,stack=
17094 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
17095 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
17096 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17097 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17098 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17099 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17100 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17101 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17102 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17103 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17104 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17105 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17106 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17107 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17108 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17109 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17110 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17111 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17112 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17113 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17114 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17115 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17116 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
17117 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
17118 (@value{GDBP})
17119 @end smallexample
17120
17121 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
17122
17123 @smallexample
17124 (@value{GDBP})
17125 -stack-list-frames 3 5
17126 ^done,stack=
17127 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17128 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17129 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17130 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17131 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17132 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17133 (@value{GDBP})
17134 @end smallexample
17135
17136 Show a single frame:
17137
17138 @smallexample
17139 (@value{GDBP})
17140 -stack-list-frames 3 3
17141 ^done,stack=
17142 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17143 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17144 (@value{GDBP})
17145 @end smallexample
17146
17147
17148 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
17149 @findex -stack-list-locals
17150
17151 @subsubheading Synopsis
17152
17153 @smallexample
17154 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
17155 @end smallexample
17156
17157 Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
17158 argument of 0 prints only the names of the variables, with argument of 1
17159 prints also their values.
17160
17161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17162
17163 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
17164
17165 @subsubheading Example
17166
17167 @smallexample
17168 (@value{GDBP})
17169 -stack-list-locals 0
17170 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
17171 (@value{GDBP})
17172 -stack-list-locals 1
17173 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
17174 @{name="C",value="3"@}]
17175 (@value{GDBP})
17176 @end smallexample
17177
17178
17179 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
17180 @findex -stack-select-frame
17181
17182 @subsubheading Synopsis
17183
17184 @smallexample
17185 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
17186 @end smallexample
17187
17188 Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
17189 the stack.
17190
17191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17192
17193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
17194 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
17195
17196 @subsubheading Example
17197
17198 @smallexample
17199 (@value{GDBP})
17200 -stack-select-frame 2
17201 ^done
17202 (@value{GDBP})
17203 @end smallexample
17204
17205 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17206 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
17207 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
17208
17209
17210 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
17211 @findex -symbol-info-address
17212
17213 @subsubheading Synopsis
17214
17215 @smallexample
17216 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
17217 @end smallexample
17218
17219 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
17220
17221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17222
17223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
17224
17225 @subsubheading Example
17226 N.A.
17227
17228
17229 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
17230 @findex -symbol-info-file
17231
17232 @subsubheading Synopsis
17233
17234 @smallexample
17235 -symbol-info-file
17236 @end smallexample
17237
17238 Show the file for the symbol.
17239
17240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17241
17242 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
17243 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
17244
17245 @subsubheading Example
17246 N.A.
17247
17248
17249 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
17250 @findex -symbol-info-function
17251
17252 @subsubheading Synopsis
17253
17254 @smallexample
17255 -symbol-info-function
17256 @end smallexample
17257
17258 Show which function the symbol lives in.
17259
17260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17261
17262 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
17263
17264 @subsubheading Example
17265 N.A.
17266
17267
17268 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
17269 @findex -symbol-info-line
17270
17271 @subsubheading Synopsis
17272
17273 @smallexample
17274 -symbol-info-line
17275 @end smallexample
17276
17277 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
17278
17279 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17280
17281 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
17282 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
17283
17284 @subsubheading Example
17285 N.A.
17286
17287
17288 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
17289 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
17290
17291 @subsubheading Synopsis
17292
17293 @smallexample
17294 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17295 @end smallexample
17296
17297 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17298
17299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17300
17301 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17302
17303 @subsubheading Example
17304 N.A.
17305
17306
17307 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17308 @findex -symbol-list-functions
17309
17310 @subsubheading Synopsis
17311
17312 @smallexample
17313 -symbol-list-functions
17314 @end smallexample
17315
17316 List the functions in the executable.
17317
17318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17319
17320 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17321 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17322
17323 @subsubheading Example
17324 N.A.
17325
17326
17327 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
17328 @findex -symbol-list-lines
17329
17330 @subsubheading Synopsis
17331
17332 @smallexample
17333 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
17334 @end smallexample
17335
17336 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
17337 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
17338 ascending PC order.
17339
17340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17341
17342 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
17343
17344 @subsubheading Example
17345 @smallexample
17346 (@value{GDBP})
17347 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
17348 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
17349 (@value{GDBP})
17350 @end smallexample
17351
17352
17353 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17354 @findex -symbol-list-types
17355
17356 @subsubheading Synopsis
17357
17358 @smallexample
17359 -symbol-list-types
17360 @end smallexample
17361
17362 List all the type names.
17363
17364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17365
17366 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17367 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17368
17369 @subsubheading Example
17370 N.A.
17371
17372
17373 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17374 @findex -symbol-list-variables
17375
17376 @subsubheading Synopsis
17377
17378 @smallexample
17379 -symbol-list-variables
17380 @end smallexample
17381
17382 List all the global and static variable names.
17383
17384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17385
17386 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17387
17388 @subsubheading Example
17389 N.A.
17390
17391
17392 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17393 @findex -symbol-locate
17394
17395 @subsubheading Synopsis
17396
17397 @smallexample
17398 -symbol-locate
17399 @end smallexample
17400
17401 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17402
17403 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17404
17405 @subsubheading Example
17406 N.A.
17407
17408
17409 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17410 @findex -symbol-type
17411
17412 @subsubheading Synopsis
17413
17414 @smallexample
17415 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17416 @end smallexample
17417
17418 Show type of @var{variable}.
17419
17420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17421
17422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17423 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17424
17425 @subsubheading Example
17426 N.A.
17427
17428
17429 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17430 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17431 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17432
17433
17434 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17435 @findex -target-attach
17436
17437 @subsubheading Synopsis
17438
17439 @smallexample
17440 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17441 @end smallexample
17442
17443 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17444
17445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17446
17447 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17448
17449 @subsubheading Example
17450 N.A.
17451
17452
17453 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17454 @findex -target-compare-sections
17455
17456 @subsubheading Synopsis
17457
17458 @smallexample
17459 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17460 @end smallexample
17461
17462 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17463 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17464
17465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17466
17467 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17468
17469 @subsubheading Example
17470 N.A.
17471
17472
17473 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17474 @findex -target-detach
17475
17476 @subsubheading Synopsis
17477
17478 @smallexample
17479 -target-detach
17480 @end smallexample
17481
17482 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17483
17484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17485
17486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17487
17488 @subsubheading Example
17489
17490 @smallexample
17491 (@value{GDBP})
17492 -target-detach
17493 ^done
17494 (@value{GDBP})
17495 @end smallexample
17496
17497
17498 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
17499 @findex -target-disconnect
17500
17501 @subsubheading Synopsis
17502
17503 @example
17504 -target-disconnect
17505 @end example
17506
17507 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17508
17509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17510
17511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
17512
17513 @subsubheading Example
17514
17515 @smallexample
17516 (@value{GDBP})
17517 -target-disconnect
17518 ^done
17519 (@value{GDBP})
17520 @end smallexample
17521
17522
17523 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17524 @findex -target-download
17525
17526 @subsubheading Synopsis
17527
17528 @smallexample
17529 -target-download
17530 @end smallexample
17531
17532 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17533 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17534
17535 @table @samp
17536 @item section
17537 The name of the section.
17538 @item section-sent
17539 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17540 @item section-size
17541 The size of the section.
17542 @item total-sent
17543 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17544 @item total-size
17545 The size of the overall executable to download.
17546 @end table
17547
17548 @noindent
17549 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17550 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17551
17552 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17553 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17554
17555 @table @samp
17556 @item section
17557 The name of the section.
17558 @item section-size
17559 The size of the section.
17560 @item total-size
17561 The size of the overall executable to download.
17562 @end table
17563
17564 @noindent
17565 At the end, a summary is printed.
17566
17567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17568
17569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17570
17571 @subsubheading Example
17572
17573 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17574 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17575
17576 @smallexample
17577 (@value{GDBP})
17578 -target-download
17579 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17580 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17581 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17582 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17583 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17584 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17585 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17586 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17587 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17588 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17589 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17590 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17591 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17592 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17593 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17594 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17595 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17596 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17597 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17598 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17599 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17600 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17601 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17602 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17603 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17604 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17605 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17606 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17607 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17608 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17609 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17610 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17611 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17612 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17613 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17614 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17615 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17616 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17617 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17618 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17619 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17620 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17621 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17622 write-rate="429"
17623 (@value{GDBP})
17624 @end smallexample
17625
17626
17627 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17628 @findex -target-exec-status
17629
17630 @subsubheading Synopsis
17631
17632 @smallexample
17633 -target-exec-status
17634 @end smallexample
17635
17636 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17637 not, for instance).
17638
17639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17640
17641 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17642
17643 @subsubheading Example
17644 N.A.
17645
17646
17647 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17648 @findex -target-list-available-targets
17649
17650 @subsubheading Synopsis
17651
17652 @smallexample
17653 -target-list-available-targets
17654 @end smallexample
17655
17656 List the possible targets to connect to.
17657
17658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17659
17660 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17661
17662 @subsubheading Example
17663 N.A.
17664
17665
17666 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17667 @findex -target-list-current-targets
17668
17669 @subsubheading Synopsis
17670
17671 @smallexample
17672 -target-list-current-targets
17673 @end smallexample
17674
17675 Describe the current target.
17676
17677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17678
17679 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17680 other things).
17681
17682 @subsubheading Example
17683 N.A.
17684
17685
17686 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17687 @findex -target-list-parameters
17688
17689 @subsubheading Synopsis
17690
17691 @smallexample
17692 -target-list-parameters
17693 @end smallexample
17694
17695 @c ????
17696
17697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17698
17699 No equivalent.
17700
17701 @subsubheading Example
17702 N.A.
17703
17704
17705 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17706 @findex -target-select
17707
17708 @subsubheading Synopsis
17709
17710 @smallexample
17711 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17712 @end smallexample
17713
17714 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17715
17716 @table @samp
17717 @item @var{type}
17718 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17719 @item @var{parameters}
17720 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17721 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17722 @end table
17723
17724 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17725 which the target program is, in the following form:
17726
17727 @smallexample
17728 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17729 args=[@var{arg list}]
17730 @end smallexample
17731
17732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17733
17734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17735
17736 @subsubheading Example
17737
17738 @smallexample
17739 (@value{GDBP})
17740 -target-select async /dev/ttya
17741 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17742 (@value{GDBP})
17743 @end smallexample
17744
17745 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17746 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17747 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17748
17749
17750 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17751 @findex -thread-info
17752
17753 @subsubheading Synopsis
17754
17755 @smallexample
17756 -thread-info
17757 @end smallexample
17758
17759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17760
17761 No equivalent.
17762
17763 @subsubheading Example
17764 N.A.
17765
17766
17767 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17768 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
17769
17770 @subsubheading Synopsis
17771
17772 @smallexample
17773 -thread-list-all-threads
17774 @end smallexample
17775
17776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17777
17778 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
17779
17780 @subsubheading Example
17781 N.A.
17782
17783
17784 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
17785 @findex -thread-list-ids
17786
17787 @subsubheading Synopsis
17788
17789 @smallexample
17790 -thread-list-ids
17791 @end smallexample
17792
17793 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
17794 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
17795
17796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17797
17798 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
17799
17800 @subsubheading Example
17801
17802 No threads present, besides the main process:
17803
17804 @smallexample
17805 (@value{GDBP})
17806 -thread-list-ids
17807 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
17808 (@value{GDBP})
17809 @end smallexample
17810
17811
17812 Several threads:
17813
17814 @smallexample
17815 (@value{GDBP})
17816 -thread-list-ids
17817 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17818 number-of-threads="3"
17819 (@value{GDBP})
17820 @end smallexample
17821
17822
17823 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
17824 @findex -thread-select
17825
17826 @subsubheading Synopsis
17827
17828 @smallexample
17829 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
17830 @end smallexample
17831
17832 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
17833 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
17834
17835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17836
17837 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
17838
17839 @subsubheading Example
17840
17841 @smallexample
17842 (@value{GDBP})
17843 -exec-next
17844 ^running
17845 (@value{GDBP})
17846 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
17847 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
17848 (@value{GDBP})
17849 -thread-list-ids
17850 ^done,
17851 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17852 number-of-threads="3"
17853 (@value{GDBP})
17854 -thread-select 3
17855 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
17856 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
17857 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
17858 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
17859 (@value{GDBP})
17860 @end smallexample
17861
17862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17863 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
17864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
17865
17866 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
17867
17868 @c @subheading -trace-actions
17869
17870 @c @subheading -trace-delete
17871
17872 @c @subheading -trace-disable
17873
17874 @c @subheading -trace-dump
17875
17876 @c @subheading -trace-enable
17877
17878 @c @subheading -trace-exists
17879
17880 @c @subheading -trace-find
17881
17882 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
17883
17884 @c @subheading -trace-info
17885
17886 @c @subheading -trace-insert
17887
17888 @c @subheading -trace-list
17889
17890 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
17891
17892 @c @subheading -trace-save
17893
17894 @c @subheading -trace-start
17895
17896 @c @subheading -trace-stop
17897
17898
17899 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17900 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
17901 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
17902
17903
17904 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17905
17906 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
17907 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
17908 used by @code{Insight}.
17909
17910 The two main reasons for that are:
17911
17912 @enumerate 1
17913 @item
17914 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
17915
17916 @item
17917 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
17918 now).
17919 @end enumerate
17920
17921 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
17922 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
17923 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
17924 hints about their use.
17925
17926 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
17927 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
17928 least, the following operations:
17929
17930 @itemize @bullet
17931 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
17932 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
17933 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
17934 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
17935 @end itemize
17936
17937 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17938
17939 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17940 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
17941 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
17942 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
17943 examining or changing its properties.
17944
17945 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
17946 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
17947 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
17948 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
17949 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
17950
17951 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
17952 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
17953 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
17954 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
17955 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
17956 for pointers, etc.).
17957
17958 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
17959 access this functionality:
17960
17961 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
17962 @item @strong{Operation}
17963 @tab @strong{Description}
17964
17965 @item @code{-var-create}
17966 @tab create a variable object
17967 @item @code{-var-delete}
17968 @tab delete the variable object and its children
17969 @item @code{-var-set-format}
17970 @tab set the display format of this variable
17971 @item @code{-var-show-format}
17972 @tab show the display format of this variable
17973 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
17974 @tab tells how many children this object has
17975 @item @code{-var-list-children}
17976 @tab return a list of the object's children
17977 @item @code{-var-info-type}
17978 @tab show the type of this variable object
17979 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
17980 @tab print what this variable object represents
17981 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
17982 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
17983 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
17984 @tab get the value of this variable
17985 @item @code{-var-assign}
17986 @tab set the value of this variable
17987 @item @code{-var-update}
17988 @tab update the variable and its children
17989 @end multitable
17990
17991 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
17992 how it can be used.
17993
17994 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
17995
17996 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
17997 @findex -var-create
17998
17999 @subsubheading Synopsis
18000
18001 @smallexample
18002 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
18003 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
18004 @end smallexample
18005
18006 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
18007 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
18008 register.
18009
18010 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
18011 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
18012 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
18013 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
18014 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
18015
18016 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
18017 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
18018 frame should be used.
18019
18020 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
18021 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
18022
18023 @itemize @bullet
18024 @item
18025 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
18026
18027 @item
18028 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
18029
18030 @item
18031 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
18032 @end itemize
18033
18034 @subsubheading Result
18035
18036 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
18037 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
18038 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
18039
18040 @smallexample
18041 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
18042 @end smallexample
18043
18044
18045 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
18046 @findex -var-delete
18047
18048 @subsubheading Synopsis
18049
18050 @smallexample
18051 -var-delete @var{name}
18052 @end smallexample
18053
18054 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
18055
18056 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
18057
18058
18059 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
18060 @findex -var-set-format
18061
18062 @subsubheading Synopsis
18063
18064 @smallexample
18065 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
18066 @end smallexample
18067
18068 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
18069 @var{format-spec}.
18070
18071 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
18072
18073 @smallexample
18074 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
18075 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
18076 @end smallexample
18077
18078
18079 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
18080 @findex -var-show-format
18081
18082 @subsubheading Synopsis
18083
18084 @smallexample
18085 -var-show-format @var{name}
18086 @end smallexample
18087
18088 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
18089
18090 @smallexample
18091 @var{format} @expansion{}
18092 @var{format-spec}
18093 @end smallexample
18094
18095
18096 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
18097 @findex -var-info-num-children
18098
18099 @subsubheading Synopsis
18100
18101 @smallexample
18102 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
18103 @end smallexample
18104
18105 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
18106
18107 @smallexample
18108 numchild=@var{n}
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111
18112 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
18113 @findex -var-list-children
18114
18115 @subsubheading Synopsis
18116
18117 @smallexample
18118 -var-list-children @var{name}
18119 @end smallexample
18120
18121 Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object:
18122
18123 @smallexample
18124 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18125 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
18126 @end smallexample
18127
18128
18129 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
18130 @findex -var-info-type
18131
18132 @subsubheading Synopsis
18133
18134 @smallexample
18135 -var-info-type @var{name}
18136 @end smallexample
18137
18138 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
18139 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
18140 @value{GDBN} CLI:
18141
18142 @smallexample
18143 type=@var{typename}
18144 @end smallexample
18145
18146
18147 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
18148 @findex -var-info-expression
18149
18150 @subsubheading Synopsis
18151
18152 @smallexample
18153 -var-info-expression @var{name}
18154 @end smallexample
18155
18156 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
18157
18158 @smallexample
18159 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 @noindent
18163 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
18164
18165 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
18166 @findex -var-show-attributes
18167
18168 @subsubheading Synopsis
18169
18170 @smallexample
18171 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
18172 @end smallexample
18173
18174 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
18175
18176 @smallexample
18177 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
18178 @end smallexample
18179
18180 @noindent
18181 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
18182
18183 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
18184 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
18185
18186 @subsubheading Synopsis
18187
18188 @smallexample
18189 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
18190 @end smallexample
18191
18192 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
18193 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
18194 for the object:
18195
18196 @smallexample
18197 value=@var{value}
18198 @end smallexample
18199
18200 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
18201 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
18202
18203 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
18204 @findex -var-assign
18205
18206 @subsubheading Synopsis
18207
18208 @smallexample
18209 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
18210 @end smallexample
18211
18212 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
18213 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
18214 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
18215 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
18216
18217 @subsubheading Example
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 (@value{GDBP})
18221 -var-assign var1 3
18222 ^done,value="3"
18223 (@value{GDBP})
18224 -var-update *
18225 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
18226 (@value{GDBP})
18227 @end smallexample
18228
18229 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
18230 @findex -var-update
18231
18232 @subsubheading Synopsis
18233
18234 @smallexample
18235 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
18236 @end smallexample
18237
18238 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
18239 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
18240 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
18241
18242
18243 @node Annotations
18244 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
18245
18246 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
18247 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
18248 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
18249 relatively high level.
18250
18251 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
18252 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
18253
18254 @ignore
18255 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
18256 @end ignore
18257
18258 @menu
18259 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
18260 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
18261 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
18262 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
18263 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
18264 * Annotations for Running::
18265 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
18266 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
18267 @end menu
18268
18269 @node Annotations Overview
18270 @section What is an Annotation?
18271 @cindex annotations
18272
18273 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
18274 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
18275 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
18276 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
18277 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
18278 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
18279 cannot contain newline characters.
18280
18281 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
18282 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
18283 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
18284 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
18285 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
18286 means those three characters as output.
18287
18288 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
18289 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
18290 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
18291 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
18292 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
18293 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
18294 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
18295 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
18296 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). This chapter
18297 describes level 3 annotations.
18298
18299 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
18300
18301 @smallexample
18302 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
18303 GNU gdb 6.0
18304 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18305 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
18306 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
18307 under certain conditions.
18308 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
18309 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
18310 for details.
18311 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
18312
18313 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18314 (gdb)
18315 ^Z^Zprompt
18316 @kbd{quit}
18317
18318 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18319 $
18320 @end smallexample
18321
18322 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
18323 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
18324 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
18325 output from @value{GDBN}.
18326
18327 @node Server Prefix
18328 @section The Server Prefix
18329 @cindex server prefix for annotations
18330
18331 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18332 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
18333 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18334 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18335 pressed on a line by itself.
18336
18337 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18338 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18339 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18340
18341 @node Prompting
18342 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18343
18344 @cindex annotations for prompts
18345 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18346 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18347 over, etc.
18348
18349 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18350 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18351 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18352 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18353 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18354 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18355 features the following annotations:
18356
18357 @smallexample
18358 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18359 ^Z^Zprompt
18360 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18361 @end smallexample
18362
18363 The input types are
18364
18365 @table @code
18366 @findex pre-prompt
18367 @findex prompt
18368 @findex post-prompt
18369 @item prompt
18370 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18371
18372 @findex pre-commands
18373 @findex commands
18374 @findex post-commands
18375 @item commands
18376 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18377 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18378
18379 @findex pre-overload-choice
18380 @findex overload-choice
18381 @findex post-overload-choice
18382 @item overload-choice
18383 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18384
18385 @findex pre-query
18386 @findex query
18387 @findex post-query
18388 @item query
18389 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18390
18391 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18392 @findex prompt-for-continue
18393 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
18394 @item prompt-for-continue
18395 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18396 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18397 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18398 presence of annotations.
18399 @end table
18400
18401 @node Errors
18402 @section Errors
18403 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18404
18405 @findex quit
18406 @smallexample
18407 ^Z^Zquit
18408 @end smallexample
18409
18410 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18411
18412 @findex error
18413 @smallexample
18414 ^Z^Zerror
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18418
18419 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18420 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18421 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18422 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18423 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18424 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18425 to the top level.
18426
18427 @findex error-begin
18428 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18429
18430 @smallexample
18431 ^Z^Zerror-begin
18432 @end smallexample
18433
18434 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18435 message.
18436
18437 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18438 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18439 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18440
18441 @node Invalidation
18442 @section Invalidation Notices
18443
18444 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18445 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18446 changed.
18447
18448 @table @code
18449 @findex frames-invalid
18450 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18451
18452 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18453 have changed.
18454
18455 @findex breakpoints-invalid
18456 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18457
18458 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18459 deleted a breakpoint.
18460 @end table
18461
18462 @node Annotations for Running
18463 @section Running the Program
18464 @cindex annotations for running programs
18465
18466 @findex starting
18467 @findex stopping
18468 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
18469 @code{step} or @code{continue},
18470
18471 @smallexample
18472 ^Z^Zstarting
18473 @end smallexample
18474
18475 is output. When the program stops,
18476
18477 @smallexample
18478 ^Z^Zstopped
18479 @end smallexample
18480
18481 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18482 annotations describe how the program stopped.
18483
18484 @table @code
18485 @findex exited
18486 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18487 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18488 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18489
18490 @findex signalled
18491 @findex signal-name
18492 @findex signal-name-end
18493 @findex signal-string
18494 @findex signal-string-end
18495 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
18496 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18497 annotation continues:
18498
18499 @smallexample
18500 @var{intro-text}
18501 ^Z^Zsignal-name
18502 @var{name}
18503 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18504 @var{middle-text}
18505 ^Z^Zsignal-string
18506 @var{string}
18507 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18508 @var{end-text}
18509 @end smallexample
18510
18511 @noindent
18512 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18513 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18514 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18515 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18516 user's benefit and have no particular format.
18517
18518 @findex signal
18519 @item ^Z^Zsignal
18520 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18521 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18522 terminated with it.
18523
18524 @findex breakpoint
18525 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18526 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18527
18528 @findex watchpoint
18529 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18530 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18531 @end table
18532
18533 @node Source Annotations
18534 @section Displaying Source
18535 @cindex annotations for source display
18536
18537 @findex source
18538 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18539
18540 @smallexample
18541 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18542 @end smallexample
18543
18544 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18545 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18546 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18547 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18548 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18549 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18550 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18551 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18552 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18553 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18554 depend on the language).
18555
18556 @node GDB Bugs
18557 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18558 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18559 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
18560
18561 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
18562
18563 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18564 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18565 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18566 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
18567
18568 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18569 information that enables us to fix the bug.
18570
18571 @menu
18572 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18573 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
18574 @end menu
18575
18576 @node Bug Criteria
18577 @section Have you found a bug?
18578 @cindex bug criteria
18579
18580 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
18581
18582 @itemize @bullet
18583 @cindex fatal signal
18584 @cindex debugger crash
18585 @cindex crash of debugger
18586 @item
18587 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18588 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18589
18590 @cindex error on valid input
18591 @item
18592 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18593 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18594 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
18595
18596 @cindex invalid input
18597 @item
18598 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18599 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18600 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18601 for traditional practice''.
18602
18603 @item
18604 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18605 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
18606 @end itemize
18607
18608 @node Bug Reporting
18609 @section How to report bugs
18610 @cindex bug reports
18611 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18612
18613 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18614 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18615 contact that organization first.
18616
18617 You can find contact information for many support companies and
18618 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18619 distribution.
18620 @c should add a web page ref...
18621
18622 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18623 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18624 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18625 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18626 be used.
18627
18628 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18629 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18630 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18631 @samp{bug-gdb}.
18632
18633 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18634 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18635 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18636 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18637 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18638 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18639 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18640 bug reports to the mailing list.
18641
18642 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18643 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18644 fact or leave it out, state it!
18645
18646 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18647 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18648 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18649 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18650 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18651 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18652 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18653 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18654 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
18655
18656 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18657 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18658 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18659 self-contained.
18660
18661 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18662 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18663 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18664 bugs properly.
18665
18666 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
18667
18668 @itemize @bullet
18669 @item
18670 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18671 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18672 version}.
18673
18674 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18675 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
18676
18677 @item
18678 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18679 version number.
18680
18681 @item
18682 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18683 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
18684
18685 @item
18686 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18687 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18688 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18689 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18690 compilers.
18691
18692 @item
18693 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
18694 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
18695 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
18696 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
18697
18698 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
18699 and then we might not encounter the bug.
18700
18701 @item
18702 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
18703 reproduce the bug.
18704
18705 @item
18706 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
18707 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
18708
18709 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
18710 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
18711 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
18712 a chance to make a mistake.
18713
18714 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
18715 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
18716 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
18717 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
18718 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
18719 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
18720 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
18721 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
18722
18723 @item
18724 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
18725 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
18726 it by context, not by line number.
18727
18728 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
18729 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
18730
18731 @end itemize
18732
18733 Here are some things that are not necessary:
18734
18735 @itemize @bullet
18736 @item
18737 A description of the envelope of the bug.
18738
18739 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
18740 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
18741 changes will not affect it.
18742
18743 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
18744 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
18745 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
18746 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
18747
18748 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
18749 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
18750 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
18751 less time, and so on.
18752
18753 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
18754 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
18755
18756 @item
18757 A patch for the bug.
18758
18759 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
18760 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
18761 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
18762 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
18763
18764 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
18765 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
18766 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
18767 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
18768
18769 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
18770 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
18771 help us to understand.
18772
18773 @item
18774 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
18775
18776 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
18777 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
18778 @end itemize
18779
18780 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
18781 @c and consists of the two following files:
18782 @c rluser.texinfo
18783 @c inc-hist.texinfo
18784 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
18785 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
18786 @include rluser.texinfo
18787 @include inc-hist.texinfo
18788
18789
18790 @node Formatting Documentation
18791 @appendix Formatting Documentation
18792
18793 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
18794 @cindex reference card
18795 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
18796 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
18797 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
18798 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
18799 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
18800 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
18801
18802 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
18803 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 make refcard.dvi
18807 @end smallexample
18808
18809 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
18810 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
18811 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
18812 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
18813 your @sc{dvi} output program.
18814
18815 @cindex documentation
18816
18817 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
18818 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
18819 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
18820 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
18821 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
18822 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
18823
18824 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
18825 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
18826 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
18827 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
18828 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
18829 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
18830 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
18831 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
18832
18833 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
18834 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
18835 @code{makeinfo}.
18836
18837 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
18838 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
18839 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
18840
18841 @smallexample
18842 cd gdb
18843 make gdb.info
18844 @end smallexample
18845
18846 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
18847 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
18848 Texinfo definitions file.
18849
18850 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
18851 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
18852 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
18853 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
18854 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
18855 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
18856 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
18857
18858 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
18859 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
18860 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
18861 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
18862 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
18863 directory.
18864
18865 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
18866 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
18867 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
18868 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
18869
18870 @smallexample
18871 make gdb.dvi
18872 @end smallexample
18873
18874 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
18875
18876 @node Installing GDB
18877 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
18878 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
18879 @cindex installation
18880 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
18881
18882 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
18883 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
18884 build the @code{gdb} program.
18885 @iftex
18886 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
18887 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
18888 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
18889 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
18890 @end iftex
18891
18892 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
18893 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
18894 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
18895
18896 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
18897 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
18898
18899 @table @code
18900 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
18901 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
18902
18903 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
18904 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
18905
18906 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
18907 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
18908
18909 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
18910 @sc{gnu} include files
18911
18912 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
18913 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
18914
18915 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
18916 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
18917
18918 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
18919 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
18920
18921 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
18922 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
18923
18924 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
18925 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
18926 @end table
18927
18928 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
18929 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
18930 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
18931
18932 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
18933 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
18934 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
18935 argument.
18936
18937 For example:
18938
18939 @smallexample
18940 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
18941 ./configure @var{host}
18942 make
18943 @end smallexample
18944
18945 @noindent
18946 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
18947 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
18948 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
18949 correct value by examining your system.)
18950
18951 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
18952 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
18953 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
18954 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
18955
18956 @need 750
18957 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
18958 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
18959 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
18960
18961 @smallexample
18962 sh configure @var{host}
18963 @end smallexample
18964
18965 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
18966 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
18967 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
18968 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
18969 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
18970
18971 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
18972 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
18973 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
18974 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
18975 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
18976 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
18977 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
18978 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
18979 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
18980
18981 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
18982 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
18983 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
18984 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
18985 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
18986
18987 @menu
18988 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
18989 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
18990 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
18991 @end menu
18992
18993 @node Separate Objdir
18994 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
18995
18996 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
18997 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
18998 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
18999 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
19000 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
19001 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
19002 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
19003 program specified there.
19004
19005 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
19006 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
19007 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
19008 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
19009 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
19010 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
19011
19012 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
19013 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
19014
19015 @smallexample
19016 @group
19017 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19018 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
19019 cd ../gdb-sun4
19020 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
19021 make
19022 @end group
19023 @end smallexample
19024
19025 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
19026 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
19027 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
19028 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
19029 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
19030 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
19031
19032 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
19033 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
19034 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
19035 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
19036 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19037
19038 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
19039 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19040 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19041 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19042 You specify a cross-debugging target by
19043 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
19044
19045 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19046 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19047 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
19048
19049 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19050 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19051 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19052 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19053 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
19054
19055 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19056 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19057 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19058 with each other.
19059
19060 @node Config Names
19061 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
19062
19063 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19064 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19065 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19066 of information in the following pattern:
19067
19068 @smallexample
19069 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
19070 @end smallexample
19071
19072 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19073 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19074 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
19075
19076 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19077 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19078 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19079 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19080 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19081 abbreviations---for example:
19082
19083 @smallexample
19084 % sh config.sub i386-linux
19085 i386-pc-linux-gnu
19086 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
19087 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19088 % sh config.sub hp9k700
19089 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19090 % sh config.sub sun4
19091 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19092 % sh config.sub sun3
19093 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19094 % sh config.sub i986v
19095 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19096 @end smallexample
19097
19098 @noindent
19099 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19100 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
19101
19102 @node Configure Options
19103 @section @code{configure} options
19104
19105 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19106 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19107 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19108 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
19109
19110 @smallexample
19111 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19112 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19113 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19114 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19115 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19116 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19117 @var{host}
19118 @end smallexample
19119
19120 @noindent
19121 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19122 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19123 @samp{--}.
19124
19125 @table @code
19126 @item --help
19127 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
19128
19129 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
19130 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19131 @file{@var{dir}}.
19132
19133 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19134 Configure the source to install programs under directory
19135 @file{@var{dir}}.
19136
19137 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19138 @need 2000
19139 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19140 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19141 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19142 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19143 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19144 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19145 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19146 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19147 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19148 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19149 @var{dirname}.
19150
19151 @item --norecursion
19152 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19153 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
19154
19155 @item --target=@var{target}
19156 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19157 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19158 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
19159
19160 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
19161
19162 @item @var{host} @dots{}
19163 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
19164
19165 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19166 @end table
19167
19168 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19169 needed for special purposes only.
19170
19171 @node Maintenance Commands
19172 @appendix Maintenance Commands
19173 @cindex maintenance commands
19174 @cindex internal commands
19175
19176 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19177 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19178 These commands are provided here for reference.
19179
19180 @table @code
19181 @kindex maint info breakpoints
19182 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19183 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19184 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19185 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19186 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19187 is shown:
19188
19189 @table @code
19190 @item breakpoint
19191 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
19192
19193 @item watchpoint
19194 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
19195
19196 @item longjmp
19197 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19198 @code{longjmp} calls.
19199
19200 @item longjmp resume
19201 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
19202
19203 @item until
19204 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
19205
19206 @item finish
19207 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
19208
19209 @item shlib events
19210 Shared library events.
19211
19212 @end table
19213
19214 @kindex maint internal-error
19215 @kindex maint internal-warning
19216 @item maint internal-error
19217 @itemx maint internal-warning
19218 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19219 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19220 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19221 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19222 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19223 @value{GDBN} session.
19224
19225 @smallexample
19226 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19227 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19228 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19229 debugging may prove unreliable.
19230 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19231 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19232 (gdb)
19233 @end smallexample
19234
19235 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19236 warning message.
19237
19238 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
19239 @item maint print dummy-frames
19240
19241 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
19242
19243 @smallexample
19244 (gdb) @kbd{b add}
19245 @dots{}
19246 (gdb) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
19247 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
19248 58 return (a + b);
19249 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
19250 @dots{}
19251 (gdb) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
19252 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
19253 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
19254 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
19255 (gdb)
19256 @end smallexample
19257
19258 Takes an optional file parameter.
19259
19260 @kindex maint print registers
19261 @kindex maint print raw-registers
19262 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
19263 @kindex maint print register-groups
19264 @item maint print registers
19265 @itemx maint print raw-registers
19266 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
19267 @itemx maint print register-groups
19268 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19269
19270 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19271 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19272 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19273 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19274 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19275 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
19276
19277 Takes an optional file parameter.
19278
19279 @kindex maint print reggroups
19280 @item maint print reggroups
19281 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19282
19283 Takes an optional file parameter.
19284
19285 @smallexample
19286 (gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
19287 Group Type
19288 general user
19289 float user
19290 all user
19291 vector user
19292 system user
19293 save internal
19294 restore internal
19295 @end smallexample
19296
19297 @kindex maint set profile
19298 @kindex maint show profile
19299 @cindex profiling GDB
19300 @item maint set profile
19301 @itemx maint show profile
19302 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19303
19304 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19305 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19306 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19307 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19308 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19309 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19310 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19311
19312 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
19313 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
19314
19315 @end table
19316
19317
19318 @node Remote Protocol
19319 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
19320
19321 @menu
19322 * Overview::
19323 * Packets::
19324 * Stop Reply Packets::
19325 * General Query Packets::
19326 * Register Packet Format::
19327 * Examples::
19328 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
19329 @end menu
19330
19331 @node Overview
19332 @section Overview
19333
19334 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19335 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19336 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19337 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
19338
19339 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
19340 transmitted and received data respectfully.
19341
19342 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19343 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19344 @cindex remote serial protocol
19345 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19346 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19347 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19348 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
19349
19350 @smallexample
19351 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19352 @end smallexample
19353 @noindent
19354
19355 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19356 @noindent
19357 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19358 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19359 eight bit unsigned checksum).
19360
19361 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19362 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
19363
19364 @smallexample
19365 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19366 @end smallexample
19367
19368 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19369 @noindent
19370 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19371 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19372 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
19373
19374 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19375 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19376 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19377 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19378 retransmission):
19379
19380 @smallexample
19381 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19382 <- @code{+}
19383 @end smallexample
19384 @noindent
19385
19386 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19387 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19388 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19389 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
19390
19391 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19392 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19393 exceptions).
19394
19395 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
19396 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
19397 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
19398 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
19399
19400 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19401 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19402 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
19403
19404 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19405 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19406 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19407 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19408 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19409 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19410 value greater than 126 should not be used.
19411
19412 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
19413 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
19414 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
19415
19416 So:
19417 @smallexample
19418 "@code{0* }"
19419 @end smallexample
19420 @noindent
19421 means the same as "0000".
19422
19423 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19424 error number. That number is not well defined.
19425
19426 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19427 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19428 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19429 on that response.
19430
19431 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19432 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
19433 optional.
19434
19435 @node Packets
19436 @section Packets
19437
19438 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19439 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19440
19441 @table @r
19442
19443 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
19444 @cindex @code{!} packet
19445
19446 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19447 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19448 debugged.
19449
19450 Reply:
19451 @table @samp
19452 @item OK
19453 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
19454 @end table
19455
19456 @item @code{?} --- last signal
19457 @cindex @code{?} packet
19458
19459 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19460 step and continue.
19461
19462 Reply:
19463 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19464
19465 @item @code{a} --- reserved
19466
19467 Reserved for future use.
19468
19469 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19470 @cindex @code{A} packet
19471
19472 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19473 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
19474 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19475
19476 Reply:
19477 @table @samp
19478 @item OK
19479 @item E@var{NN}
19480 @end table
19481
19482 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19483 @cindex @code{b} packet
19484
19485 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19486
19487 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19488 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19489 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19490
19491 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19492 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19493 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19494 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19495 of view, nothing actually happened.}
19496
19497 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19498 @cindex @code{B} packet
19499
19500 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
19501 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19502
19503 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19504 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
19505
19506 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19507 @cindex @code{c} packet
19508
19509 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19510 current address.
19511
19512 Reply:
19513 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19514
19515 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19516 @cindex @code{C} packet
19517
19518 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19519 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
19520
19521 Reply:
19522 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19523
19524 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19525 @cindex @code{d} packet
19526
19527 Toggle debug flag.
19528
19529 @item @code{D} --- detach
19530 @cindex @code{D} packet
19531
19532 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
19533 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
19534
19535 Reply:
19536 @table @samp
19537 @item @emph{no response}
19538 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
19539 @end table
19540
19541 @item @code{e} --- reserved
19542
19543 Reserved for future use.
19544
19545 @item @code{E} --- reserved
19546
19547 Reserved for future use.
19548
19549 @item @code{f} --- reserved
19550
19551 Reserved for future use.
19552
19553 @item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19554 @cindex @code{F} packet
19555
19556 This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19557 sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19558 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
19559
19560 @item @code{g} --- read registers
19561 @anchor{read registers packet}
19562 @cindex @code{g} packet
19563
19564 Read general registers.
19565
19566 Reply:
19567 @table @samp
19568 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19569 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19570 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19571 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
19572 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
19573 @var{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
19574 specification of several standard @code{g} packets is specified below.
19575 @item E@var{NN}
19576 for an error.
19577 @end table
19578
19579 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19580 @cindex @code{G} packet
19581
19582 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19583 data.
19584
19585 Reply:
19586 @table @samp
19587 @item OK
19588 for success
19589 @item E@var{NN}
19590 for an error
19591 @end table
19592
19593 @item @code{h} --- reserved
19594
19595 Reserved for future use.
19596
19597 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
19598 @cindex @code{H} packet
19599
19600 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
19601 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19602 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19603 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19604 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19605
19606 Reply:
19607 @table @samp
19608 @item OK
19609 for success
19610 @item E@var{NN}
19611 for an error
19612 @end table
19613
19614 @c FIXME: JTC:
19615 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19616 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19617 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19618 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19619 @c described. For example:
19620 @c
19621 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19622 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19623 @c otherwise returns current registers.
19624 @c
19625 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19626 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19627 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
19628
19629 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19630 @anchor{cycle step packet}
19631 @cindex @code{i} packet
19632
19633 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19634 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19635 step starting at that address.
19636
19637 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19638 @cindex @code{I} packet
19639
19640 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19641
19642 @item @code{j} --- reserved
19643
19644 Reserved for future use.
19645
19646 @item @code{J} --- reserved
19647
19648 Reserved for future use.
19649
19650 @item @code{k} --- kill request
19651 @cindex @code{k} packet
19652
19653 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
19654 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19655 thread?)}.
19656
19657 @item @code{K} --- reserved
19658
19659 Reserved for future use.
19660
19661 @item @code{l} --- reserved
19662
19663 Reserved for future use.
19664
19665 @item @code{L} --- reserved
19666
19667 Reserved for future use.
19668
19669 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19670 @cindex @code{m} packet
19671
19672 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19673 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
19674 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
19675 transfer mechanism is needed.}
19676
19677 Reply:
19678 @table @samp
19679 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19680 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19681 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
19682 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
19683 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19684 needed.}
19685 @item E@var{NN}
19686 @var{NN} is errno
19687 @end table
19688
19689 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19690 @cindex @code{M} packet
19691
19692 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19693 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
19694
19695 Reply:
19696 @table @samp
19697 @item OK
19698 for success
19699 @item E@var{NN}
19700 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
19701 written).
19702 @end table
19703
19704 @item @code{n} --- reserved
19705
19706 Reserved for future use.
19707
19708 @item @code{N} --- reserved
19709
19710 Reserved for future use.
19711
19712 @item @code{o} --- reserved
19713
19714 Reserved for future use.
19715
19716 @item @code{O} --- reserved
19717
19718 Reserved for future use.
19719
19720 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
19721 @cindex @code{p} packet
19722
19723 @xref{write register packet}.
19724
19725 Reply:
19726 @table @samp
19727 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
19728 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
19729 @end table
19730
19731 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
19732 @anchor{write register packet}
19733 @cindex @code{P} packet
19734
19735 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
19736 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
19737
19738 Reply:
19739 @table @samp
19740 @item OK
19741 for success
19742 @item E@var{NN}
19743 for an error
19744 @end table
19745
19746 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
19747 @anchor{general query packet}
19748 @cindex @code{q} packet
19749
19750 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
19751 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
19752 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
19753 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
19754 that they match the full @var{query} name.
19755
19756 Reply:
19757 @table @samp
19758 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19759 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
19760 @item E@var{NN}
19761 error reply
19762 @item
19763 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
19764 @end table
19765
19766 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
19767 @cindex @code{Q} packet
19768
19769 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
19770
19771 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
19772
19773 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
19774 @cindex @code{r} packet
19775
19776 Reset the entire system.
19777
19778 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
19779 @cindex @code{R} packet
19780
19781 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
19782 This packet is only available in extended mode.
19783
19784 Reply:
19785 @table @samp
19786 @item @emph{no reply}
19787 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
19788 @end table
19789
19790 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
19791 @cindex @code{s} packet
19792
19793 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19794 same address.
19795
19796 Reply:
19797 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19798
19799 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
19800 @anchor{step with signal packet}
19801 @cindex @code{S} packet
19802
19803 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
19804
19805 Reply:
19806 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19807
19808 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
19809 @cindex @code{t} packet
19810
19811 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
19812 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
19813 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
19814
19815 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
19816 @cindex @code{T} packet
19817
19818 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
19819
19820 Reply:
19821 @table @samp
19822 @item OK
19823 thread is still alive
19824 @item E@var{NN}
19825 thread is dead
19826 @end table
19827
19828 @item @code{u} --- reserved
19829
19830 Reserved for future use.
19831
19832 @item @code{U} --- reserved
19833
19834 Reserved for future use.
19835
19836 @item @code{v} --- verbose packet prefix
19837
19838 Packets starting with @code{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
19839 up to the first @code{;} or @code{?} (or the end of the packet).
19840
19841 @item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}[@code{:}@var{tid}]]... --- extended resume
19842 @cindex @code{vCont} packet
19843
19844 Resume the inferior. Different actions may be specified for each thread.
19845 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
19846 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
19847 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
19848 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
19849 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
19850
19851 @table @code
19852 @item c
19853 Continue.
19854 @item C@var{sig}
19855 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
19856 @item s
19857 Step.
19858 @item S@var{sig}
19859 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
19860 @end table
19861
19862 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
19863 not supported in @code{vCont}.
19864
19865 Reply:
19866 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19867
19868 @item @code{vCont?} --- extended resume query
19869 @cindex @code{vCont?} packet
19870
19871 Query support for the @code{vCont} packet.
19872
19873 Reply:
19874 @table @samp
19875 @item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}]...
19876 The @code{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
19877 command in the @code{vCont} packet.
19878 @item
19879 The @code{vCont} packet is not supported.
19880 @end table
19881
19882 @item @code{V} --- reserved
19883
19884 Reserved for future use.
19885
19886 @item @code{w} --- reserved
19887
19888 Reserved for future use.
19889
19890 @item @code{W} --- reserved
19891
19892 Reserved for future use.
19893
19894 @item @code{x} --- reserved
19895
19896 Reserved for future use.
19897
19898 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
19899 @cindex @code{X} packet
19900
19901 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
19902 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
19903 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
19904
19905 Reply:
19906 @table @samp
19907 @item OK
19908 for success
19909 @item E@var{NN}
19910 for an error
19911 @end table
19912
19913 @item @code{y} --- reserved
19914
19915 Reserved for future use.
19916
19917 @item @code{Y} reserved
19918
19919 Reserved for future use.
19920
19921 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19922 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19923 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
19924 @cindex @code{z} packet
19925 @cindex @code{Z} packets
19926
19927 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
19928 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
19929 @var{length} bytes.
19930
19931 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
19932 separately.
19933
19934 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
19935 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
19936 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
19937 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
19938 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
19939 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
19940
19941 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19942 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19943 @cindex @code{z0} packet
19944 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
19945
19946 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
19947 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
19948
19949 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
19950 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
19951 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
19952 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
19953 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
19954
19955 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
19956 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
19957 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
19958 target, is not defined.}
19959
19960 Reply:
19961 @table @samp
19962 @item OK
19963 success
19964 @item
19965 not supported
19966 @item E@var{NN}
19967 for an error
19968 @end table
19969
19970 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19971 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19972 @cindex @code{z1} packet
19973 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
19974
19975 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
19976 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
19977
19978 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
19979 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
19980
19981 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
19982 movement.}
19983
19984 Reply:
19985 @table @samp
19986 @item OK
19987 success
19988 @item
19989 not supported
19990 @item E@var{NN}
19991 for an error
19992 @end table
19993
19994 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19995 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19996 @cindex @code{z2} packet
19997 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
19998
19999 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
20000
20001 Reply:
20002 @table @samp
20003 @item OK
20004 success
20005 @item
20006 not supported
20007 @item E@var{NN}
20008 for an error
20009 @end table
20010
20011 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20012 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20013 @cindex @code{z3} packet
20014 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
20015
20016 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
20017
20018 Reply:
20019 @table @samp
20020 @item OK
20021 success
20022 @item
20023 not supported
20024 @item E@var{NN}
20025 for an error
20026 @end table
20027
20028 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20029 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20030 @cindex @code{z4} packet
20031 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
20032
20033 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
20034
20035 Reply:
20036 @table @samp
20037 @item OK
20038 success
20039 @item
20040 not supported
20041 @item E@var{NN}
20042 for an error
20043 @end table
20044
20045 @end table
20046
20047 @node Stop Reply Packets
20048 @section Stop Reply Packets
20049 @cindex stop reply packets
20050
20051 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
20052 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
20053 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
20054 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
20055 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
20056 conventions is used.
20057
20058 @table @samp
20059
20060 @item S@var{AA}
20061 @var{AA} is the signal number
20062
20063 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
20064 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
20065
20066 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
20067 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
20068 by @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread},
20069 @var{r...} = thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} =
20070 (@samp{watch} | @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data
20071 address, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting
20072 with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...},
20073 @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can extend the
20074 protocol.
20075
20076 @item W@var{AA}
20077
20078 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
20079 applicable to certain targets.
20080
20081 @item X@var{AA}
20082
20083 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
20084
20085 @item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
20086
20087 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
20088 @code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
20089 base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
20090 The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
20091 the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
20092 is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
20093
20094 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
20095
20096 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20097 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20098 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20099
20100 @item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20101
20102 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20103 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20104 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20105 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20106 system calls.
20107
20108 @var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20109 system call.
20110
20111 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20112 a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20113 an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20114 packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20115 @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20116 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20117
20118 @end table
20119
20120 @node General Query Packets
20121 @section General Query Packets
20122
20123 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
20124
20125 @table @r
20126
20127 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20128
20129 Return the current thread id.
20130
20131 Reply:
20132 @table @samp
20133 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
20134 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
20135 @item *
20136 Any other reply implies the old pid.
20137 @end table
20138
20139 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20140
20141 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
20142
20143 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20144 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20145 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20146 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20147 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20148 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
20149
20150 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20151
20152 Reply:
20153 @table @samp
20154 @item @code{m}@var{id}
20155 A single thread id
20156 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20157 a comma-separated list of thread ids
20158 @item @code{l}
20159 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20160 @end table
20161
20162 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20163 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20164 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
20165 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20166 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
20167
20168 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20169
20170 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20171 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20172 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20173 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20174 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20175 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20176 Mutex''.
20177
20178 Reply:
20179 @table @samp
20180 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
20181 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20182 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
20183 attributes.
20184 @end table
20185
20186 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
20187
20188 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20189 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20190 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20191 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20192 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20193 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
20194
20195 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20196 (see above).
20197
20198 Reply:
20199 @table @samp
20200 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
20201 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20202 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20203 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
20204 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20205 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
20206 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
20207 @end table
20208
20209 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20210
20211 Reply:
20212 @table @samp
20213 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20214 An error (such as memory fault)
20215 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20216 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20217 @end table
20218
20219 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
20220
20221 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20222 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20223 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20224 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
20225
20226 Reply:
20227 @table @samp
20228 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20229 @end table
20230
20231 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20232
20233 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20234 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
20235
20236 Reply:
20237 @table @samp
20238 @item *
20239 @end table
20240
20241 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
20242
20243 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20244
20245 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
20246 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20247 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
20248 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20249 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20250 interpreter may have security implications}.
20251
20252 Reply:
20253 @table @samp
20254 @item OK
20255 A command response with no output.
20256 @item @var{OUTPUT}
20257 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
20258 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20259 Indicate a badly formed request.
20260 @item @samp{}
20261 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
20262 @end table
20263
20264 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
20265
20266 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20267 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
20268
20269 Reply:
20270 @table @samp
20271 @item @code{OK}
20272 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20273 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20274 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20275 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20276 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20277 @end table
20278
20279 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20280
20281 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20282
20283 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20284 target has previously requested.
20285
20286 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20287 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20288 will be empty.
20289
20290 Reply:
20291 @table @samp
20292 @item @code{OK}
20293 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20294 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20295 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20296 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20297 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20298 @end table
20299
20300 @end table
20301
20302 @node Register Packet Format
20303 @section Register Packet Format
20304
20305 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
20306 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20307 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20308 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20309 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20310 most-significant - least-significant.
20311
20312 @table @r
20313
20314 @item MIPS32
20315
20316 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
20317 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20318 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
20319
20320 @item MIPS64
20321
20322 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20323 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20324 as @code{MIPS32}.
20325
20326 @end table
20327
20328 @node Examples
20329 @section Examples
20330
20331 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20332 does not get any direct output:
20333
20334 @smallexample
20335 -> @code{R00}
20336 <- @code{+}
20337 @emph{target restarts}
20338 -> @code{?}
20339 <- @code{+}
20340 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20341 -> @code{+}
20342 @end smallexample
20343
20344 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
20345
20346 @smallexample
20347 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
20348 <- @code{+}
20349 -> @code{s}
20350 <- @code{+}
20351 @emph{time passes}
20352 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20353 -> @code{+}
20354 -> @code{g}
20355 <- @code{+}
20356 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
20357 -> @code{+}
20358 @end smallexample
20359
20360 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20361 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20362 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20363
20364 @menu
20365 * File-I/O Overview::
20366 * Protocol basics::
20367 * The `F' request packet::
20368 * The `F' reply packet::
20369 * Memory transfer::
20370 * The Ctrl-C message::
20371 * Console I/O::
20372 * The isatty call::
20373 * The system call::
20374 * List of supported calls::
20375 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20376 * Constants::
20377 * File-I/O Examples::
20378 @end menu
20379
20380 @node File-I/O Overview
20381 @subsection File-I/O Overview
20382 @cindex file-i/o overview
20383
20384 The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20385 target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20386 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20387 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20388 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20389 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20390
20391 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20392 it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20393 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20394 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20395 when data is transmitted.
20396
20397 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20398 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20399 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20400 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20401 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20402 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20403
20404 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20405 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20406 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20407 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20408 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20409
20410 @smallexample
20411 (gdb) continue
20412 <- target requests 'system call X'
20413 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20414 -> GDB returns result
20415 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20416 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20420 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20421 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20422 system are not supported by this protocol.
20423
20424 @node Protocol basics
20425 @subsection Protocol basics
20426 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20427
20428 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20429 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
20430 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
20431 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20432 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20433 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20434 to call the appropriate host system call:
20435
20436 @itemize @bullet
20437 @item
20438 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20439
20440 @item
20441 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20442 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
20443 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
20444 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20445
20446 @end itemize
20447
20448 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20449
20450 @itemize @bullet
20451 @item
20452 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20453 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20454 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20455 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20456 packet.
20457
20458 @item
20459 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20460 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20461
20462 @item
20463 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
20464
20465 @item
20466 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20467
20468 @item
20469 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20470 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20471 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20472 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20473 packet.
20474
20475 @end itemize
20476
20477 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20478 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20479
20480 @itemize @bullet
20481 @item
20482 Return value.
20483
20484 @item
20485 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20486
20487 @item
20488 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20489
20490 @end itemize
20491
20492 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20493 the latest continue or step action.
20494
20495 @node The `F' request packet
20496 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
20497 @cindex file-i/o request packet
20498 @cindex @code{F} request packet
20499
20500 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20501
20502 @table @samp
20503
20504 @smallexample
20505 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20506 @end smallexample
20507
20508 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20509 This is just the name of the function.
20510
20511 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20512
20513 @end table
20514
20515 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20516 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20517 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20518 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20519 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20520 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20521
20522 @node The `F' reply packet
20523 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20524 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
20525 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
20526
20527 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20528
20529 @table @samp
20530
20531 @smallexample
20532 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20533 @end smallexample
20534
20535 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20536
20537 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20538 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20539
20540 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20541 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20542 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20543
20544 @smallexample
20545 F0,0,C
20546 @end smallexample
20547
20548 @noindent
20549 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20550
20551 @smallexample
20552 F-1,4,C
20553 @end smallexample
20554
20555 @noindent
20556 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20557
20558 @end table
20559
20560 @node Memory transfer
20561 @subsection Memory transfer
20562 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20563
20564 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20565 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20566 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20567 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20568 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20569 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20570
20571 @node The Ctrl-C message
20572 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
20573 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20574
20575 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20576 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20577 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20578 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20579 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
20580 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
20581 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20582 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20583
20584 @itemize @bullet
20585 @item
20586 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20587
20588 @item
20589 The system call on the host has been finished.
20590
20591 @end itemize
20592
20593 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20594 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20595 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20596 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20597 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20598 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20599
20600 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20601 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20602 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20603 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20604 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20605 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20606 or the full action has been completed.
20607
20608 @node Console I/O
20609 @subsection Console I/O
20610 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20611
20612 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20613 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20614 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20615 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20616 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
20617 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20618 conditions is met:
20619
20620 @itemize @bullet
20621 @item
20622 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20623 @code{read}
20624 system call is treated as finished.
20625
20626 @item
20627 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20628 line feed.
20629
20630 @item
20631 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20632 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20633
20634 @end itemize
20635
20636 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20637 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20638 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20639 is stopped on users request.
20640
20641 @node The isatty call
20642 @subsection The isatty(3) call
20643 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20644
20645 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20646 is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
20647 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20648 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20649 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20650 needed.
20651
20652 @node The system call
20653 @subsection The system(3) call
20654 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20655
20656 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20657 is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20658 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20659 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20660 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20661 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20662 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20663
20664 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
20665 by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
20666 entering
20667
20668 @table @samp
20669 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20670 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20671 @end table
20672
20673 Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20674
20675 @table @samp
20676 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20677 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20678 @end table
20679
20680 The current setting is shown by typing
20681
20682 @table @samp
20683 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20684 @item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20685 @end table
20686
20687 @node List of supported calls
20688 @subsection List of supported calls
20689 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
20690
20691 @menu
20692 * open::
20693 * close::
20694 * read::
20695 * write::
20696 * lseek::
20697 * rename::
20698 * unlink::
20699 * stat/fstat::
20700 * gettimeofday::
20701 * isatty::
20702 * system::
20703 @end menu
20704
20705 @node open
20706 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
20707 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
20708
20709 @smallexample
20710 @exdent Synopsis:
20711 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
20712 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
20713
20714 @exdent Request:
20715 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
20716 @end smallexample
20717
20718 @noindent
20719 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20720
20721 @table @code
20722 @item O_CREAT
20723 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
20724 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
20725 are concerned.
20726
20727 @item O_EXCL
20728 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
20729 an error and open() fails.
20730
20731 @item O_TRUNC
20732 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
20733 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
20734 truncated to length 0.
20735
20736 @item O_APPEND
20737 The file is opened in append mode.
20738
20739 @item O_RDONLY
20740 The file is opened for reading only.
20741
20742 @item O_WRONLY
20743 The file is opened for writing only.
20744
20745 @item O_RDWR
20746 The file is opened for reading and writing.
20747
20748 @noindent
20749 Each other bit is silently ignored.
20750
20751 @end table
20752
20753 @noindent
20754 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20755
20756 @table @code
20757 @item S_IRUSR
20758 User has read permission.
20759
20760 @item S_IWUSR
20761 User has write permission.
20762
20763 @item S_IRGRP
20764 Group has read permission.
20765
20766 @item S_IWGRP
20767 Group has write permission.
20768
20769 @item S_IROTH
20770 Others have read permission.
20771
20772 @item S_IWOTH
20773 Others have write permission.
20774
20775 @noindent
20776 Each other bit is silently ignored.
20777
20778 @end table
20779
20780 @smallexample
20781 @exdent Return value:
20782 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
20783 occured.
20784
20785 @exdent Errors:
20786 @end smallexample
20787
20788 @table @code
20789 @item EEXIST
20790 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
20791
20792 @item EISDIR
20793 pathname refers to a directory.
20794
20795 @item EACCES
20796 The requested access is not allowed.
20797
20798 @item ENAMETOOLONG
20799 pathname was too long.
20800
20801 @item ENOENT
20802 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
20803
20804 @item ENODEV
20805 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
20806
20807 @item EROFS
20808 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
20809 write access was requested.
20810
20811 @item EFAULT
20812 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
20813
20814 @item ENOSPC
20815 No space on device to create the file.
20816
20817 @item EMFILE
20818 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
20819
20820 @item ENFILE
20821 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
20822 has been reached.
20823
20824 @item EINTR
20825 The call was interrupted by the user.
20826 @end table
20827
20828 @node close
20829 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
20830 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
20831
20832 @smallexample
20833 @exdent Synopsis:
20834 int close(int fd);
20835
20836 @exdent Request:
20837 Fclose,fd
20838
20839 @exdent Return value:
20840 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
20841
20842 @exdent Errors:
20843 @end smallexample
20844
20845 @table @code
20846 @item EBADF
20847 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
20848
20849 @item EINTR
20850 The call was interrupted by the user.
20851 @end table
20852
20853 @node read
20854 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
20855 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
20856
20857 @smallexample
20858 @exdent Synopsis:
20859 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
20860
20861 @exdent Request:
20862 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
20863
20864 @exdent Return value:
20865 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
20866 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
20867 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
20868
20869 @exdent Errors:
20870 @end smallexample
20871
20872 @table @code
20873 @item EBADF
20874 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20875 reading.
20876
20877 @item EFAULT
20878 buf is an invalid pointer value.
20879
20880 @item EINTR
20881 The call was interrupted by the user.
20882 @end table
20883
20884 @node write
20885 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
20886 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
20887
20888 @smallexample
20889 @exdent Synopsis:
20890 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
20891
20892 @exdent Request:
20893 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
20894
20895 @exdent Return value:
20896 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
20897 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
20898 is returned.
20899
20900 @exdent Errors:
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 @table @code
20904 @item EBADF
20905 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20906 writing.
20907
20908 @item EFAULT
20909 buf is an invalid pointer value.
20910
20911 @item EFBIG
20912 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
20913 host specific maximum file size allowed.
20914
20915 @item ENOSPC
20916 No space on device to write the data.
20917
20918 @item EINTR
20919 The call was interrupted by the user.
20920 @end table
20921
20922 @node lseek
20923 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
20924 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
20925
20926 @smallexample
20927 @exdent Synopsis:
20928 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
20929
20930 @exdent Request:
20931 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
20932 @end smallexample
20933
20934 @code{flag} is one of:
20935
20936 @table @code
20937 @item SEEK_SET
20938 The offset is set to offset bytes.
20939
20940 @item SEEK_CUR
20941 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
20942 bytes.
20943
20944 @item SEEK_END
20945 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
20946 bytes.
20947 @end table
20948
20949 @smallexample
20950 @exdent Return value:
20951 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
20952 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
20953 value of -1 is returned.
20954
20955 @exdent Errors:
20956 @end smallexample
20957
20958 @table @code
20959 @item EBADF
20960 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
20961
20962 @item ESPIPE
20963 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
20964
20965 @item EINVAL
20966 flag is not a proper value.
20967
20968 @item EINTR
20969 The call was interrupted by the user.
20970 @end table
20971
20972 @node rename
20973 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
20974 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
20975
20976 @smallexample
20977 @exdent Synopsis:
20978 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
20979
20980 @exdent Request:
20981 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
20982
20983 @exdent Return value:
20984 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
20985
20986 @exdent Errors:
20987 @end smallexample
20988
20989 @table @code
20990 @item EISDIR
20991 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
20992 directory.
20993
20994 @item EEXIST
20995 newpath is a non-empty directory.
20996
20997 @item EBUSY
20998 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
20999 process.
21000
21001 @item EINVAL
21002 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
21003 of itself.
21004
21005 @item ENOTDIR
21006 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
21007 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
21008 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
21009
21010 @item EFAULT
21011 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
21012
21013 @item EACCES
21014 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21015
21016 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21017
21018 oldpath or newpath was too long.
21019
21020 @item ENOENT
21021 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
21022
21023 @item EROFS
21024 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21025
21026 @item ENOSPC
21027 The device containing the file has no room for the new
21028 directory entry.
21029
21030 @item EINTR
21031 The call was interrupted by the user.
21032 @end table
21033
21034 @node unlink
21035 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
21036 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
21037
21038 @smallexample
21039 @exdent Synopsis:
21040 int unlink(const char *pathname);
21041
21042 @exdent Request:
21043 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
21044
21045 @exdent Return value:
21046 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21047
21048 @exdent Errors:
21049 @end smallexample
21050
21051 @table @code
21052 @item EACCES
21053 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21054
21055 @item EPERM
21056 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
21057
21058 @item EBUSY
21059 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
21060 being used by another process.
21061
21062 @item EFAULT
21063 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21064
21065 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21066 pathname was too long.
21067
21068 @item ENOENT
21069 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21070
21071 @item ENOTDIR
21072 A component of the path is not a directory.
21073
21074 @item EROFS
21075 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21076
21077 @item EINTR
21078 The call was interrupted by the user.
21079 @end table
21080
21081 @node stat/fstat
21082 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21083 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21084 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21085
21086 @smallexample
21087 @exdent Synopsis:
21088 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21089 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21090
21091 @exdent Request:
21092 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21093 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21094
21095 @exdent Return value:
21096 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21097
21098 @exdent Errors:
21099 @end smallexample
21100
21101 @table @code
21102 @item EBADF
21103 fd is not a valid open file.
21104
21105 @item ENOENT
21106 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21107 path is an empty string.
21108
21109 @item ENOTDIR
21110 A component of the path is not a directory.
21111
21112 @item EFAULT
21113 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21114
21115 @item EACCES
21116 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21117
21118 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21119 pathname was too long.
21120
21121 @item EINTR
21122 The call was interrupted by the user.
21123 @end table
21124
21125 @node gettimeofday
21126 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21127 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21128
21129 @smallexample
21130 @exdent Synopsis:
21131 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21132
21133 @exdent Request:
21134 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21135
21136 @exdent Return value:
21137 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21138
21139 @exdent Errors:
21140 @end smallexample
21141
21142 @table @code
21143 @item EINVAL
21144 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21145
21146 @item EFAULT
21147 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21148 @end table
21149
21150 @node isatty
21151 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21152 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21153
21154 @smallexample
21155 @exdent Synopsis:
21156 int isatty(int fd);
21157
21158 @exdent Request:
21159 Fisatty,fd
21160
21161 @exdent Return value:
21162 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21163
21164 @exdent Errors:
21165 @end smallexample
21166
21167 @table @code
21168 @item EINTR
21169 The call was interrupted by the user.
21170 @end table
21171
21172 @node system
21173 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
21174 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 @exdent Synopsis:
21178 int system(const char *command);
21179
21180 @exdent Request:
21181 Fsystem,commandptr/len
21182
21183 @exdent Return value:
21184 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21185 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21186 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21187 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21188 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21189
21190 @exdent Errors:
21191 @end smallexample
21192
21193 @table @code
21194 @item EINTR
21195 The call was interrupted by the user.
21196 @end table
21197
21198 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21199 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21200 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21201
21202 @menu
21203 * Integral datatypes::
21204 * Pointer values::
21205 * struct stat::
21206 * struct timeval::
21207 @end menu
21208
21209 @node Integral datatypes
21210 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21211 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21212
21213 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21214
21215 @smallexample
21216 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21217 @end smallexample
21218
21219 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21220 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21221
21222 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21223
21224 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21225 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21226
21227 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21228
21229 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21230 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21231 byte order.
21232
21233 @node Pointer values
21234 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21235 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21236
21237 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21238 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21239 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21240 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21241
21242 @smallexample
21243 @code{1aaf/12}
21244 @end smallexample
21245
21246 @noindent
21247 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21248 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21249 the trailing null byte. Example:
21250
21251 @smallexample
21252 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21253 @end smallexample
21254
21255 @noindent
21256 is transmitted as
21257
21258 @smallexample
21259 @code{123456/d}
21260 @end smallexample
21261
21262 @node struct stat
21263 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21264 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21265
21266 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21267 as follows:
21268
21269 @smallexample
21270 struct stat @{
21271 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21272 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21273 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21274 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21275 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21276 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21277 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21278 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21279 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21280 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21281 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21282 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21283 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21284 @};
21285 @end smallexample
21286
21287 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21288 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21289 structure is of size 64 bytes.
21290
21291 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21292 range of values.
21293
21294 @smallexample
21295 st_dev: 0 file
21296 1 console
21297
21298 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21299
21300 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21301 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21302
21303 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21304
21305 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21306
21307 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21308
21309 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21310 These values have a host and file system dependent
21311 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21312 don't support exact timing values.
21313 @end smallexample
21314
21315 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21316 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21317 continuing.
21318
21319 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21320 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21321 get truncated on the target.
21322
21323 @node struct timeval
21324 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21325 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21326
21327 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21328 is defined as follows:
21329
21330 @smallexample
21331 struct timeval @{
21332 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21333 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21334 @};
21335 @end smallexample
21336
21337 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21338 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21339 structure is of size 8 bytes.
21340
21341 @node Constants
21342 @subsection Constants
21343 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21344
21345 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21346 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21347 values before and after the call as needed.
21348
21349 @menu
21350 * Open flags::
21351 * mode_t values::
21352 * Errno values::
21353 * Lseek flags::
21354 * Limits::
21355 @end menu
21356
21357 @node Open flags
21358 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21359 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21360
21361 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21362
21363 @smallexample
21364 O_RDONLY 0x0
21365 O_WRONLY 0x1
21366 O_RDWR 0x2
21367 O_APPEND 0x8
21368 O_CREAT 0x200
21369 O_TRUNC 0x400
21370 O_EXCL 0x800
21371 @end smallexample
21372
21373 @node mode_t values
21374 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21375 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21376
21377 All values are given in octal representation.
21378
21379 @smallexample
21380 S_IFREG 0100000
21381 S_IFDIR 040000
21382 S_IRUSR 0400
21383 S_IWUSR 0200
21384 S_IXUSR 0100
21385 S_IRGRP 040
21386 S_IWGRP 020
21387 S_IXGRP 010
21388 S_IROTH 04
21389 S_IWOTH 02
21390 S_IXOTH 01
21391 @end smallexample
21392
21393 @node Errno values
21394 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21395 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21396
21397 All values are given in decimal representation.
21398
21399 @smallexample
21400 EPERM 1
21401 ENOENT 2
21402 EINTR 4
21403 EBADF 9
21404 EACCES 13
21405 EFAULT 14
21406 EBUSY 16
21407 EEXIST 17
21408 ENODEV 19
21409 ENOTDIR 20
21410 EISDIR 21
21411 EINVAL 22
21412 ENFILE 23
21413 EMFILE 24
21414 EFBIG 27
21415 ENOSPC 28
21416 ESPIPE 29
21417 EROFS 30
21418 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21419 EUNKNOWN 9999
21420 @end smallexample
21421
21422 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21423 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21424
21425 @node Lseek flags
21426 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21427 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 SEEK_SET 0
21431 SEEK_CUR 1
21432 SEEK_END 2
21433 @end smallexample
21434
21435 @node Limits
21436 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21437 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21438
21439 All values are given in decimal representation.
21440
21441 @smallexample
21442 INT_MIN -2147483648
21443 INT_MAX 2147483647
21444 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21445 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21446 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21447 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21448 @end smallexample
21449
21450 @node File-I/O Examples
21451 @subsection File-I/O Examples
21452 @cindex file-i/o examples
21453
21454 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21455 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21456
21457 @smallexample
21458 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21459 @emph{request memory read from target}
21460 -> @code{m1234,6}
21461 <- XXXXXX
21462 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21463 -> @code{F6}
21464 @end smallexample
21465
21466 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21467 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21468
21469 @smallexample
21470 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21471 @emph{request memory write to target}
21472 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21473 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21474 -> @code{F6}
21475 @end smallexample
21476
21477 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21478 file descriptor (EBADF):
21479
21480 @smallexample
21481 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21482 -> @code{F-1,9}
21483 @end smallexample
21484
21485 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21486 host is called:
21487
21488 @smallexample
21489 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21490 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
21491 <- @code{T02}
21492 @end smallexample
21493
21494 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21495 host is called:
21496
21497 @smallexample
21498 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21499 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21500 <- @code{T02}
21501 @end smallexample
21502
21503 @include agentexpr.texi
21504
21505 @include gpl.texi
21506
21507 @include fdl.texi
21508
21509 @node Index
21510 @unnumbered Index
21511
21512 @printindex cp
21513
21514 @tex
21515 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21516 % meantime:
21517 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21518 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21519 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21520 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21521 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21522 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21523 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21524 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21525 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21526 \page\colophon
21527 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21528 @end tex
21529
21530 @bye
This page took 0.515609 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.